US20130183326A9 - Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex - Google Patents
Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20130183326A9 US20130183326A9 US13/509,072 US201013509072A US2013183326A9 US 20130183326 A9 US20130183326 A9 US 20130183326A9 US 201013509072 A US201013509072 A US 201013509072A US 2013183326 A9 US2013183326 A9 US 2013183326A9
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- complex
- polypeptide
- polynucleotide
- seq
- canceled
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 title claims abstract description 127
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 title claims abstract description 64
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 title claims abstract description 45
- 102000040430 polynucleotide Human genes 0.000 claims abstract description 171
- 108091033319 polynucleotide Proteins 0.000 claims abstract description 171
- 239000002157 polynucleotide Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 171
- 102100037795 Interleukin-6 receptor subunit beta Human genes 0.000 claims abstract description 133
- 101710152369 Interleukin-6 receptor subunit beta Proteins 0.000 claims abstract description 130
- 239000003795 chemical substances by application Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 73
- 210000003162 effector t lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 claims abstract description 38
- 239000000556 agonist Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 31
- 102000015696 Interleukins Human genes 0.000 claims abstract description 30
- 108010063738 Interleukins Proteins 0.000 claims abstract description 30
- 230000003915 cell function Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 27
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 24
- 239000011230 binding agent Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 23
- 238000012216 screening Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 3
- 210000004027 cell Anatomy 0.000 claims description 226
- 108090000765 processed proteins & peptides Proteins 0.000 claims description 141
- 102000004196 processed proteins & peptides Human genes 0.000 claims description 137
- 229920001184 polypeptide Polymers 0.000 claims description 133
- 239000012634 fragment Substances 0.000 claims description 126
- 230000014509 gene expression Effects 0.000 claims description 66
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 claims description 59
- 230000027455 binding Effects 0.000 claims description 44
- 125000003729 nucleotide group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 40
- 239000002773 nucleotide Substances 0.000 claims description 39
- 241001465754 Metazoa Species 0.000 claims description 34
- 239000000427 antigen Substances 0.000 claims description 33
- 108091007433 antigens Proteins 0.000 claims description 31
- 102000036639 antigens Human genes 0.000 claims description 31
- 108020004414 DNA Proteins 0.000 claims description 25
- 206010028980 Neoplasm Diseases 0.000 claims description 25
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 claims description 24
- 230000009870 specific binding Effects 0.000 claims description 22
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 claims description 20
- 125000003275 alpha amino acid group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 18
- 230000004913 activation Effects 0.000 claims description 16
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 claims description 16
- 230000028993 immune response Effects 0.000 claims description 16
- 101710103840 Interleukin-12 receptor subunit beta-2 Proteins 0.000 claims description 12
- 102100020792 Interleukin-12 receptor subunit beta-2 Human genes 0.000 claims description 12
- 239000008194 pharmaceutical composition Substances 0.000 claims description 11
- 201000011510 cancer Diseases 0.000 claims description 10
- 230000001965 increasing effect Effects 0.000 claims description 10
- 230000009261 transgenic effect Effects 0.000 claims description 9
- 208000023275 Autoimmune disease Diseases 0.000 claims description 5
- 230000003993 interaction Effects 0.000 claims description 5
- 230000003042 antagnostic effect Effects 0.000 claims description 4
- 208000027866 inflammatory disease Diseases 0.000 claims description 4
- 102000053602 DNA Human genes 0.000 claims description 3
- 230000001363 autoimmune Effects 0.000 claims description 3
- 210000005260 human cell Anatomy 0.000 claims description 2
- 208000037976 chronic inflammation Diseases 0.000 claims 2
- 208000037893 chronic inflammatory disorder Diseases 0.000 claims 2
- 108010002386 Interleukin-3 Proteins 0.000 claims 1
- 238000000159 protein binding assay Methods 0.000 claims 1
- 239000005557 antagonist Substances 0.000 abstract description 32
- 238000011282 treatment Methods 0.000 abstract description 26
- 108090000623 proteins and genes Proteins 0.000 description 68
- 102000004169 proteins and genes Human genes 0.000 description 58
- 102000005962 receptors Human genes 0.000 description 43
- 108020003175 receptors Proteins 0.000 description 43
- 150000001413 amino acids Chemical class 0.000 description 42
- 241000699670 Mus sp. Species 0.000 description 39
- 230000001629 suppression Effects 0.000 description 37
- 239000000523 sample Substances 0.000 description 36
- 238000003556 assay Methods 0.000 description 33
- 229960005486 vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 33
- 239000011324 bead Substances 0.000 description 31
- 230000001404 mediated effect Effects 0.000 description 28
- 238000009396 hybridization Methods 0.000 description 26
- 230000035755 proliferation Effects 0.000 description 22
- 210000001744 T-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 20
- 239000013615 primer Substances 0.000 description 20
- 238000001727 in vivo Methods 0.000 description 18
- 108060003951 Immunoglobulin Proteins 0.000 description 17
- 102000018358 immunoglobulin Human genes 0.000 description 17
- 238000000338 in vitro Methods 0.000 description 17
- FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium chloride Chemical compound [Na+].[Cl-] FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 16
- 239000013598 vector Substances 0.000 description 16
- 108010065805 Interleukin-12 Proteins 0.000 description 15
- 102000013462 Interleukin-12 Human genes 0.000 description 15
- 241000699666 Mus <mouse, genus> Species 0.000 description 14
- 239000003550 marker Substances 0.000 description 14
- 230000001105 regulatory effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000011664 signaling Effects 0.000 description 14
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 14
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 14
- 238000003752 polymerase chain reaction Methods 0.000 description 13
- ZHNUHDYFZUAESO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Formamide Chemical compound NC=O ZHNUHDYFZUAESO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 12
- 108010066979 Interleukin-27 Proteins 0.000 description 12
- 102100036678 Interleukin-27 subunit alpha Human genes 0.000 description 12
- 230000002950 deficient Effects 0.000 description 12
- 241001529936 Murinae Species 0.000 description 11
- 230000004071 biological effect Effects 0.000 description 11
- 239000012472 biological sample Substances 0.000 description 11
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 11
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 11
- 229940117681 interleukin-12 Drugs 0.000 description 11
- 239000003446 ligand Substances 0.000 description 11
- 210000001519 tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 11
- 102000002090 Fibronectin type III Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 108050009401 Fibronectin type III Proteins 0.000 description 10
- 108010044012 STAT1 Transcription Factor Proteins 0.000 description 10
- 108010019992 STAT4 Transcription Factor Proteins 0.000 description 10
- 102000005886 STAT4 Transcription Factor Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 102100029904 Signal transducer and activator of transcription 1-alpha/beta Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 230000003053 immunization Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 10
- 239000012528 membrane Substances 0.000 description 10
- 102000039446 nucleic acids Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 108020004707 nucleic acids Proteins 0.000 description 10
- 150000007523 nucleic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 10
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 10
- 239000006228 supernatant Substances 0.000 description 10
- 238000011740 C57BL/6 mouse Methods 0.000 description 9
- 102000004127 Cytokines Human genes 0.000 description 9
- 108090000695 Cytokines Proteins 0.000 description 9
- 125000000539 amino acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 9
- 239000003814 drug Substances 0.000 description 9
- 239000004816 latex Substances 0.000 description 9
- 229920000126 latex Polymers 0.000 description 9
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 9
- 239000011780 sodium chloride Substances 0.000 description 9
- 241000894007 species Species 0.000 description 9
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 9
- 241000283973 Oryctolagus cuniculus Species 0.000 description 8
- 208000037265 diseases, disorders, signs and symptoms Diseases 0.000 description 8
- 238000002649 immunization Methods 0.000 description 8
- 208000015181 infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 8
- 230000002401 inhibitory effect Effects 0.000 description 8
- 108020004999 messenger RNA Proteins 0.000 description 8
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 8
- 150000003384 small molecules Chemical group 0.000 description 8
- 108091093088 Amplicon Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 241000700159 Rattus Species 0.000 description 7
- IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-XLPZGREQSA-N Thymidine Chemical compound O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)C1 IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-XLPZGREQSA-N 0.000 description 7
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 7
- 238000012217 deletion Methods 0.000 description 7
- 230000037430 deletion Effects 0.000 description 7
- 201000010099 disease Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 238000002474 experimental method Methods 0.000 description 7
- 239000001963 growth medium Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000001225 therapeutic effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 108010021625 Immunoglobulin Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 6
- 102000008394 Immunoglobulin Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 6
- ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-leucine Chemical compound CC(C)C[C@H](N)C(O)=O ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 6
- ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Leucine Natural products CC(C)CC(N)C(O)=O ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Propylene glycol Chemical compound CC(O)CO DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 108010017324 STAT3 Transcription Factor Proteins 0.000 description 6
- 102100024040 Signal transducer and activator of transcription 3 Human genes 0.000 description 6
- 210000000447 Th1 cell Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- 239000002671 adjuvant Substances 0.000 description 6
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 6
- 230000009918 complex formation Effects 0.000 description 6
- -1 for example Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- 230000005847 immunogenicity Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000006698 induction Effects 0.000 description 6
- PHEDXBVPIONUQT-RGYGYFBISA-N phorbol 13-acetate 12-myristate Chemical compound C([C@]1(O)C(=O)C(C)=C[C@H]1[C@@]1(O)[C@H](C)[C@H]2OC(=O)CCCCCCCCCCCCC)C(CO)=C[C@H]1[C@H]1[C@]2(OC(C)=O)C1(C)C PHEDXBVPIONUQT-RGYGYFBISA-N 0.000 description 6
- 230000026731 phosphorylation Effects 0.000 description 6
- 238000006366 phosphorylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000013612 plasmid Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000007423 screening assay Methods 0.000 description 6
- 230000019491 signal transduction Effects 0.000 description 6
- PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Glycerine Chemical compound OCC(O)CO PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 101000617830 Homo sapiens Sterol O-acyltransferase 1 Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 102100030698 Interleukin-12 subunit alpha Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 241000829100 Macaca mulatta polyomavirus 1 Species 0.000 description 5
- DBMJMQXJHONAFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium laurylsulphate Chemical compound [Na+].CCCCCCCCCCCCOS([O-])(=O)=O DBMJMQXJHONAFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 5
- 102100021993 Sterol O-acyltransferase 1 Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 101000697584 Streptomyces lavendulae Streptothricin acetyltransferase Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 210000004241 Th2 cell Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 238000007792 addition Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000000890 antigenic effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000004663 cell proliferation Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000002299 complementary DNA Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000012636 effector Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 5
- 108020001507 fusion proteins Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 102000037865 fusion proteins Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 210000004408 hybridoma Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 210000000987 immune system Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 238000010348 incorporation Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000001939 inductive effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000003472 neutralizing effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000002644 phorbol ester Substances 0.000 description 5
- 210000003289 regulatory T cell Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 5
- 235000019333 sodium laurylsulphate Nutrition 0.000 description 5
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000002560 therapeutic procedure Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000001890 transfection Methods 0.000 description 5
- CIWBSHSKHKDKBQ-JLAZNSOCSA-N Ascorbic acid Chemical compound OC[C@H](O)[C@H]1OC(=O)C(O)=C1O CIWBSHSKHKDKBQ-JLAZNSOCSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 102000000844 Cell Surface Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 4
- 108010001857 Cell Surface Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 108091026890 Coding region Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 241000283086 Equidae Species 0.000 description 4
- 101000852964 Homo sapiens Interleukin-27 subunit beta Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 101000599056 Homo sapiens Interleukin-6 receptor subunit beta Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 108091028043 Nucleic acid sequence Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 108010029485 Protein Isoforms Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 102000001708 Protein Isoforms Human genes 0.000 description 4
- 238000011529 RT qPCR Methods 0.000 description 4
- 101710120037 Toxin CcdB Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 238000010171 animal model Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000006185 dispersion Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229940079593 drug Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 239000003937 drug carrier Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000002708 enhancing effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000012530 fluid Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000009472 formulation Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000036039 immunity Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000004615 ingredient Substances 0.000 description 4
- NOESYZHRGYRDHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N insulin Chemical compound N1C(=O)C(NC(=O)C(CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)CN)C(C)CC)CSSCC(C(NC(CO)C(=O)NC(CC(C)C)C(=O)NC(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)C(=O)NC(CCC(N)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(C)C)C(=O)NC(CCC(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(N)=O)C(=O)NC(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)C(=O)NC(CSSCC(NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(C)NC(=O)C(CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC=2NC=NC=2)NC(=O)C(CO)NC(=O)CNC2=O)C(=O)NCC(=O)NC(CCC(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)NCC(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC=CC=3)C(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC=CC=3)C(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC(O)=CC=3)C(=O)NC(C(C)O)C(=O)N3C(CCC3)C(=O)NC(CCCCN)C(=O)NC(C)C(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(N)=O)C(O)=O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)CC)NC(=O)C(CO)NC(=O)C(C(C)O)NC(=O)C1CSSCC2NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)C(CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(CC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)C(N)CC=1C=CC=CC=1)C(C)C)CC1=CN=CN1 NOESYZHRGYRDHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 230000000670 limiting effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 210000001165 lymph node Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 238000002844 melting Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000008018 melting Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000010369 molecular cloning Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000037361 pathway Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000002265 prevention Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000001681 protective effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 150000003839 salts Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 230000028327 secretion Effects 0.000 description 4
- 210000000952 spleen Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 208000024891 symptom Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 230000009466 transformation Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000013603 viral vector Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000003612 virological effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Chemical compound O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 108091032973 (ribonucleotides)n+m Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241000894006 Bacteria Species 0.000 description 3
- WVDDGKGOMKODPV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Benzyl alcohol Chemical compound OCC1=CC=CC=C1 WVDDGKGOMKODPV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 241000283690 Bos taurus Species 0.000 description 3
- 241000283707 Capra Species 0.000 description 3
- 241000701022 Cytomegalovirus Species 0.000 description 3
- 241000702421 Dependoparvovirus Species 0.000 description 3
- 206010061818 Disease progression Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 238000002965 ELISA Methods 0.000 description 3
- 102000004190 Enzymes Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108090000790 Enzymes Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241000588724 Escherichia coli Species 0.000 description 3
- LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethanol Chemical compound CCO LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 208000001382 Experimental Melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 101001057504 Homo sapiens Interferon-stimulated gene 20 kDa protein Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101001055144 Homo sapiens Interleukin-2 receptor subunit alpha Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101000914514 Homo sapiens T-cell-specific surface glycoprotein CD28 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 108090001061 Insulin Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 108010074328 Interferon-gamma Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100026878 Interleukin-2 receptor subunit alpha Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 241000124008 Mammalia Species 0.000 description 3
- 241000713333 Mouse mammary tumor virus Species 0.000 description 3
- 206010035226 Plasma cell myeloma Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 241000288906 Primates Species 0.000 description 3
- 102100024952 Protein CBFA2T1 Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108020004511 Recombinant DNA Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 108091028664 Ribonucleotide Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241000283984 Rodentia Species 0.000 description 3
- HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium hydroxide Chemical compound [OH-].[Na+] HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 3
- 241000282887 Suidae Species 0.000 description 3
- 102100027213 T-cell-specific surface glycoprotein CD28 Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108060008682 Tumor Necrosis Factor Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 239000002253 acid Substances 0.000 description 3
- 150000007513 acids Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 239000013543 active substance Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000003242 anti bacterial agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- 210000003719 b-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000020411 cell activation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000021615 conjugation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000013270 controlled release Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000001472 cytotoxic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000003247 decreasing effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I dipotassium trisodium dihydrogen phosphate hydrogen phosphate dichloride Chemical compound P(=O)(O)(O)[O-].[K+].P(=O)(O)([O-])[O-].[Na+].[Na+].[Cl-].[K+].[Cl-].[Na+] LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I 0.000 description 3
- 230000005750 disease progression Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000002612 dispersion medium Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000008030 elimination Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003379 elimination reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 229940088598 enzyme Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 239000013604 expression vector Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000013595 glycosylation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000006206 glycosylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000012010 growth Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000036541 health Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000003284 homeostatic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003018 immunoassay Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000002163 immunogen Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229940072221 immunoglobulins Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 239000007943 implant Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000002955 isolation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000002372 labelling Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000002502 liposome Substances 0.000 description 3
- 210000004698 lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 244000005700 microbiome Species 0.000 description 3
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000035772 mutation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000037125 natural defense Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000002953 phosphate buffered saline Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000003389 potentiating effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000000843 powder Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002062 proliferating effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000000069 prophylactic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000000746 purification Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000003259 recombinant expression Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000012552 review Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000002336 ribonucleotide Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000002652 ribonucleotide group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 238000002864 sequence alignment Methods 0.000 description 3
- 210000002966 serum Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000003826 tablet Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229940124597 therapeutic agent Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 102000003390 tumor necrosis factor Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 210000003462 vein Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 238000001262 western blot Methods 0.000 description 3
- YBJHBAHKTGYVGT-ZKWXMUAHSA-N (+)-Biotin Chemical compound N1C(=O)N[C@@H]2[C@H](CCCCC(=O)O)SC[C@@H]21 YBJHBAHKTGYVGT-ZKWXMUAHSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LRFVTYWOQMYALW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9H-xanthine Chemical compound O=C1NC(=O)NC2=C1NC=N2 LRFVTYWOQMYALW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000272517 Anseriformes Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000282472 Canis lupus familiaris Species 0.000 description 2
- CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon dioxide Chemical compound O=C=O CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000282693 Cercopithecidae Species 0.000 description 2
- 206010008342 Cervix carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010047041 Complementarity Determining Regions Proteins 0.000 description 2
- AOJJSUZBOXZQNB-TZSSRYMLSA-N Doxorubicin Chemical compound O([C@H]1C[C@@](O)(CC=2C(O)=C3C(=O)C=4C=CC=C(C=4C(=O)C3=C(O)C=21)OC)C(=O)CO)[C@H]1C[C@H](N)[C@H](O)[C@H](C)O1 AOJJSUZBOXZQNB-TZSSRYMLSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000196324 Embryophyta Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000282326 Felis catus Species 0.000 description 2
- 108010010803 Gelatin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N Glucose Natural products OC[C@H]1OC(O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 108010070675 Glutathione transferase Proteins 0.000 description 2
- NYHBQMYGNKIUIF-UUOKFMHZSA-N Guanosine Chemical compound C1=NC=2C(=O)NC(N)=NC=2N1[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)[C@H]1O NYHBQMYGNKIUIF-UUOKFMHZSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102100029100 Hematopoietic prostaglandin D synthase Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 101001003138 Homo sapiens Interleukin-12 receptor subunit beta-2 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000725303 Human immunodeficiency virus Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000701806 Human papillomavirus Species 0.000 description 2
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrochloric acid Chemical compound Cl VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010020751 Hypersensitivity Diseases 0.000 description 2
- XQFRJNBWHJMXHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N IDUR Chemical compound C1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C(I)=C1 XQFRJNBWHJMXHO-RRKCRQDMSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102000004877 Insulin Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 102100037850 Interferon gamma Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010050904 Interferons Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000014150 Interferons Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010002350 Interleukin-2 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000000588 Interleukin-2 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 102100036712 Interleukin-27 subunit beta Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 102000004388 Interleukin-4 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108090000978 Interleukin-4 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000713666 Lentivirus Species 0.000 description 2
- 108091007491 NSP3 Papain-like protease domains Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241001494479 Pecora Species 0.000 description 2
- 208000037581 Persistent Infection Diseases 0.000 description 2
- ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phenol Chemical compound OC1=CC=CC=C1 ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000276498 Pollachius virens Species 0.000 description 2
- 108010076504 Protein Sorting Signals Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000714474 Rous sarcoma virus Species 0.000 description 2
- 102000001712 STAT5 Transcription Factor Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010029477 STAT5 Transcription Factor Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 108010090804 Streptavidin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000950638 Symphysodon discus Species 0.000 description 2
- NKANXQFJJICGDU-QPLCGJKRSA-N Tamoxifen Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1C(/CC)=C(C=1C=CC(OCCN(C)C)=CC=1)/C1=CC=CC=C1 NKANXQFJJICGDU-QPLCGJKRSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102000000887 Transcription factor STAT Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108050007918 Transcription factor STAT Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 208000006105 Uterine Cervical Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 241000700605 Viruses Species 0.000 description 2
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003213 activating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001154 acute effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000007815 allergy Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000844 anti-bacterial effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000005809 anti-tumor immunity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229940121375 antifungal agent Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 239000003429 antifungal agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000000612 antigen-presenting cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000007864 aqueous solution Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000010323 ascorbic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 229960005070 ascorbic acid Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 239000011668 ascorbic acid Substances 0.000 description 2
- 208000006673 asthma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000001580 bacterial effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-VFUOTHLCSA-N beta-D-glucose Chemical compound OC[C@H]1O[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-VFUOTHLCSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229940022399 cancer vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 239000002775 capsule Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000006037 cell lysis Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000001516 cell proliferation assay Methods 0.000 description 2
- 201000010881 cervical cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000012707 chemical precursor Substances 0.000 description 2
- OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N chlorobutanol Chemical compound CC(C)(O)C(Cl)(Cl)Cl OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- MYSWGUAQZAJSOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N ciprofloxacin Chemical compound C12=CC(N3CCNCC3)=C(F)C=C2C(=O)C(C(=O)O)=CN1C1CC1 MYSWGUAQZAJSOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000003501 co-culture Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000012875 competitive assay Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 231100000433 cytotoxic Toxicity 0.000 description 2
- 239000005547 deoxyribonucleotide Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000002637 deoxyribonucleotide group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000003745 diagnosis Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000004069 differentiation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003028 elevating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001804 emulsifying effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000839 emulsion Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000002255 enzymatic effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000003743 erythrocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000000684 flow cytometry Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000008273 gelatin Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920000159 gelatin Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 235000019322 gelatine Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 235000011852 gelatine desserts Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 230000030279 gene silencing Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000011521 glass Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000003862 glucocorticoid Substances 0.000 description 2
- RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N glutathione Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(=O)N[C@@H](CS)C(=O)NCC(O)=O RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 235000011187 glycerol Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 238000005734 heterodimerization reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 102000047143 human IL12RB2 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N hypoxanthine Chemical compound O=C1NC=NC2=C1NC=N2 FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000001900 immune effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000009851 immunogenic response Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000001114 immunoprecipitation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000003018 immunosuppressive agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000002602 induced regulatory T cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000000411 inducer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000028709 inflammatory response Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000003112 inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229940125396 insulin Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 229940079322 interferon Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 108010093036 interleukin receptors Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000002467 interleukin receptors Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 229940028885 interleukin-4 Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 230000003834 intracellular effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000010189 intracellular transport Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000001990 intravenous administration Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000007951 isotonicity adjuster Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000011813 knockout mouse model Methods 0.000 description 2
- HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L magnesium stearate Chemical compound [Mg+2].CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 238000012423 maintenance Methods 0.000 description 2
- OSWPMRLSEDHDFF-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl salicylate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1O OSWPMRLSEDHDFF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000002156 mixing Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000002703 mutagenesis Methods 0.000 description 2
- 231100000350 mutagenesis Toxicity 0.000 description 2
- 201000000050 myeloid neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 238000007899 nucleic acid hybridization Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000002674 ointment Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000816 peptidomimetic Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000546 pharmaceutical excipient Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000008363 phosphate buffer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920001223 polyethylene glycol Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000002987 primer (paints) Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000047 product Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000012846 protein folding Effects 0.000 description 2
- 150000003254 radicals Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000006798 recombination Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005215 recombination Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000010076 replication Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000284 resting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003248 secreting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000001509 sodium citrate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910001415 sodium ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 210000004989 spleen cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 230000004936 stimulating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000007920 subcutaneous administration Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000829 suppository Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000001356 surgical procedure Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000725 suspension Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229940021747 therapeutic vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 230000000699 topical effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000013518 transcription Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000035897 transcription Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000012096 transfection reagent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000011426 transformation method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000011830 transgenic mouse model Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001052 transient effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 241000701447 unidentified baculovirus Species 0.000 description 2
- 241001430294 unidentified retrovirus Species 0.000 description 2
- 230000009385 viral infection Effects 0.000 description 2
- QGVLYPPODPLXMB-UBTYZVCOSA-N (1aR,1bS,4aR,7aS,7bS,8R,9R,9aS)-4a,7b,9,9a-tetrahydroxy-3-(hydroxymethyl)-1,1,6,8-tetramethyl-1,1a,1b,4,4a,7a,7b,8,9,9a-decahydro-5H-cyclopropa[3,4]benzo[1,2-e]azulen-5-one Chemical compound C1=C(CO)C[C@]2(O)C(=O)C(C)=C[C@H]2[C@@]2(O)[C@H](C)[C@@H](O)[C@@]3(O)C(C)(C)[C@H]3[C@@H]21 QGVLYPPODPLXMB-UBTYZVCOSA-N 0.000 description 1
- YMXHPSHLTSZXKH-RVBZMBCESA-N (2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl) 5-[(3as,4s,6ar)-2-oxo-1,3,3a,4,6,6a-hexahydrothieno[3,4-d]imidazol-4-yl]pentanoate Chemical compound C([C@H]1[C@H]2NC(=O)N[C@H]2CS1)CCCC(=O)ON1C(=O)CCC1=O YMXHPSHLTSZXKH-RVBZMBCESA-N 0.000 description 1
- IPVFGAYTKQKGBM-BYPJNBLXSA-N 1-[(2r,3s,4r,5r)-3-fluoro-4-hydroxy-5-(hydroxymethyl)oxolan-2-yl]-5-iodopyrimidine-2,4-dione Chemical compound F[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C(I)=C1 IPVFGAYTKQKGBM-BYPJNBLXSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 1-palmitoyl-2-arachidonoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OC[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OCC[N+](C)(C)C)OC(=O)CCC\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/CCCCC IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NDMPLJNOPCLANR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,4-dihydroxy-15-(4-hydroxy-18-methoxycarbonyl-5,18-seco-ibogamin-18-yl)-16-methoxy-1-methyl-6,7-didehydro-aspidospermidine-3-carboxylic acid methyl ester Natural products C1C(CC)(O)CC(CC2(C(=O)OC)C=3C(=CC4=C(C56C(C(C(O)C7(CC)C=CCN(C67)CC5)(O)C(=O)OC)N4C)C=3)OC)CN1CCC1=C2NC2=CC=CC=C12 NDMPLJNOPCLANR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- AOJJSUZBOXZQNB-VTZDEGQISA-N 4'-epidoxorubicin Chemical compound O([C@H]1C[C@@](O)(CC=2C(O)=C3C(=O)C=4C=CC=C(C=4C(=O)C3=C(O)C=21)OC)C(=O)CO)[C@H]1C[C@H](N)[C@@H](O)[C@H](C)O1 AOJJSUZBOXZQNB-VTZDEGQISA-N 0.000 description 1
- SGJHJTLXTSZBRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-amino-5-fluoro-3,4-dihydro-1h-pyrimidin-2-one Chemical compound NC1NC(=O)NC=C1F SGJHJTLXTSZBRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WYWHKKSPHMUBEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 6-Mercaptoguanine Natural products N1C(N)=NC(=S)C2=C1N=CN2 WYWHKKSPHMUBEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RJOXFJDOUQJOMQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 6-sulfanylidene-3,7-dihydropurin-2-one Chemical compound S=C1NC(=O)NC2=C1NC=N2 RJOXFJDOUQJOMQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000251468 Actinopterygii Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000002260 Alkaline Phosphatase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020004774 Alkaline Phosphatase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100033312 Alpha-2-macroglobulin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 206010003445 Ascites Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000416162 Astragalus gummifer Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000711404 Avian avulavirus 1 Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000019260 B-Cell Antigen Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010012919 B-Cell Antigen Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000003950 B-cell lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000002237 B-cell of pancreatic islet Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000035143 Bacterial infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010006654 Bleomycin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000283725 Bos Species 0.000 description 1
- 210000001266 CD8-positive T-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 102000004631 Calcineurin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010042955 Calcineurin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- UXVMQQNJUSDDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-L Calcium chloride Chemical compound [Cl-].[Cl-].[Ca+2] UXVMQQNJUSDDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- KLWPJMFMVPTNCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Camptothecin Natural products CCC1(O)C(=O)OCC2=C1C=C3C4Nc5ccccc5C=C4CN3C2=O KLWPJMFMVPTNCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000282421 Canidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010057248 Cell death Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000282994 Cervidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710163595 Chaperone protein DnaK Proteins 0.000 description 1
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-M Chloride anion Chemical compound [Cl-] VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 108010005939 Ciliary Neurotrophic Factor Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100031614 Ciliary neurotrophic factor Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000008186 Collagen Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010035532 Collagen Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108060005980 Collagenase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000029816 Collagenase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 208000035473 Communicable disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002261 Corn starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 241000699800 Cricetinae Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000699802 Cricetulus griseus Species 0.000 description 1
- MIKUYHXYGGJMLM-GIMIYPNGSA-N Crotonoside Natural products C1=NC2=C(N)NC(=O)N=C2N1[C@H]1O[C@@H](CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H]1O MIKUYHXYGGJMLM-GIMIYPNGSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CMSMOCZEIVJLDB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclophosphamide Chemical compound ClCCN(CCCl)P1(=O)NCCCO1 CMSMOCZEIVJLDB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108010006197 Cytokine Receptor gp130 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000000311 Cytosine Deaminase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010080611 Cytosine Deaminase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-FSIIMWSLSA-N D-Glucitol Natural products OC[C@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-FSIIMWSLSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-KVTDHHQDSA-N D-Mannitol Chemical compound OC[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-KVTDHHQDSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-JGWLITMVSA-N D-glucitol Chemical compound OC[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-JGWLITMVSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NYHBQMYGNKIUIF-UHFFFAOYSA-N D-guanosine Natural products C1=2NC(N)=NC(=O)C=2N=CN1C1OC(CO)C(O)C1O NYHBQMYGNKIUIF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000004544 DNA amplification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003155 DNA primer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241000450599 DNA viruses Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000004568 DNA-binding Effects 0.000 description 1
- 208000001490 Dengue Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010012310 Dengue fever Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002307 Dextran Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 102000016607 Diphtheria Toxin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010053187 Diphtheria Toxin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101100117236 Drosophila melanogaster speck gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108091035710 E-box Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100039793 E3 ubiquitin-protein ligase RAG1 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N EDTA Chemical compound OC(=O)CN(CC(O)=O)CCN(CC(O)=O)CC(O)=O KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000792859 Enema Species 0.000 description 1
- YQYJSBFKSSDGFO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Epihygromycin Natural products OC1C(O)C(C(=O)C)OC1OC(C(=C1)O)=CC=C1C=C(C)C(=O)NC1C(O)C(O)C2OCOC2C1O YQYJSBFKSSDGFO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HTIJFSOGRVMCQR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Epirubicin Natural products COc1cccc2C(=O)c3c(O)c4CC(O)(CC(OC5CC(N)C(=O)C(C)O5)c4c(O)c3C(=O)c12)C(=O)CO HTIJFSOGRVMCQR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241001331845 Equus asinus x caballus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282324 Felis Species 0.000 description 1
- GHASVSINZRGABV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fluorouracil Chemical compound FC1=CNC(=O)NC1=O GHASVSINZRGABV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000233866 Fungi Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000287828 Gallus gallus Species 0.000 description 1
- 108700039691 Genetic Promoter Regions Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010071602 Genetic polymorphism Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010024636 Glutathione Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000606768 Haemophilus influenzae Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710178376 Heat shock 70 kDa protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710152018 Heat shock cognate 70 kDa protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000032843 Hemorrhage Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000700721 Hepatitis B virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000238631 Hexapoda Species 0.000 description 1
- 241001272567 Hominoidea Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282412 Homo Species 0.000 description 1
- 101000744443 Homo sapiens E3 ubiquitin-protein ligase RAG1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101001050288 Homo sapiens Transcription factor Jun Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010001336 Horseradish Peroxidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101150003028 Hprt1 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000701109 Human adenovirus 2 Species 0.000 description 1
- 241001135569 Human adenovirus 5 Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000701024 Human betaherpesvirus 5 Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000701044 Human gammaherpesvirus 4 Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010091358 Hypoxanthine Phosphoribosyltransferase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- UGQMRVRMYYASKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hypoxanthine nucleoside Natural products OC1C(O)C(CO)OC1N1C(NC=NC2=O)=C2N=C1 UGQMRVRMYYASKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 102100029098 Hypoxanthine-guanine phosphoribosyltransferase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101150011236 IL12A gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101150117362 IL6ST gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700002232 Immediate-Early Genes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000009786 Immunoglobulin Constant Regions Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010009817 Immunoglobulin Constant Regions Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010054477 Immunoglobulin Fab Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000001706 Immunoglobulin Fab Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000018071 Immunoglobulin Fc Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010091135 Immunoglobulin Fc Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700005091 Immunoglobulin Genes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000012745 Immunoglobulin Subunits Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010079585 Immunoglobulin Subunits Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010067060 Immunoglobulin Variable Region Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000017727 Immunoglobulin Variable Region Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 208000022559 Inflammatory bowel disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 102000003996 Interferon-beta Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090000467 Interferon-beta Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000008070 Interferon-gamma Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010002352 Interleukin-1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000000589 Interleukin-1 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000013264 Interleukin-23 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010065637 Interleukin-23 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000004889 Interleukin-6 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090001005 Interleukin-6 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000008839 Kidney Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZQISRDCJNBUVMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N L-Histidinol Natural products OCC(N)CC1=CN=CN1 ZQISRDCJNBUVMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZQISRDCJNBUVMM-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-histidinol Chemical compound OC[C@@H](N)CC1=CNC=N1 ZQISRDCJNBUVMM-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FBOZXECLQNJBKD-ZDUSSCGKSA-N L-methotrexate Chemical compound C=1N=C2N=C(N)N=C(N)C2=NC=1CN(C)C1=CC=C(C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(O)=O)C=C1 FBOZXECLQNJBKD-ZDUSSCGKSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N Lactose Natural products OC[C@H]1O[C@@H](O[C@H]2[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)C(O)O[C@@H]2CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H]1O GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101710128836 Large T antigen Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000270322 Lepidosauria Species 0.000 description 1
- 108060001084 Luciferase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000005089 Luciferase Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108091054437 MHC class I family Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229930195725 Mannitol Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 102000000422 Matrix Metalloproteinase 3 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 201000005505 Measles Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000009906 Meningitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 244000246386 Mentha pulegium Species 0.000 description 1
- 235000016257 Mentha pulegium Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000004357 Mentha x piperita Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 101710201349 Metallothionein B Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100031347 Metallothionein-2 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101710094505 Metallothionein-2 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920000168 Microcrystalline cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229940121849 Mitotic inhibitor Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000034578 Multiple myelomas Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000005647 Mumps Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000699660 Mus musculus Species 0.000 description 1
- 101100232352 Mus musculus Il12rb1 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101100340196 Mus musculus Il27ra gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- NQTADLQHYWFPDB-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-Hydroxysuccinimide Chemical compound ON1C(=O)CCC1=O NQTADLQHYWFPDB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZDZOTLJHXYCWBA-VCVYQWHSSA-N N-debenzoyl-N-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-10-deacetyltaxol Chemical compound O([C@H]1[C@H]2[C@@](C([C@H](O)C3=C(C)[C@@H](OC(=O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](NC(=O)OC(C)(C)C)C=4C=CC=CC=4)C[C@]1(O)C3(C)C)=O)(C)[C@@H](O)C[C@H]1OC[C@]12OC(=O)C)C(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 ZDZOTLJHXYCWBA-VCVYQWHSSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229930193140 Neomycin Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 108020004711 Nucleic Acid Probes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108020005187 Oligonucleotide Probes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700020796 Oncogene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010082522 Oncostatin M Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100030098 Oncostatin-M-specific receptor subunit beta Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000038030 PI3Ks Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108091007960 PI3Ks Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229910019142 PO4 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229930012538 Paclitaxel Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 241000282577 Pan troglodytes Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010067372 Pancreatic elastase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000282320 Panthera leo Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282376 Panthera tigris Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010067902 Peptide Library Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 201000005702 Pertussis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000286209 Phasianidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 101100124346 Photorhabdus laumondii subsp. laumondii (strain DSM 15139 / CIP 105565 / TT01) hisCD gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000000474 Poliomyelitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002732 Polyanhydride Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000954 Polyglycolide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001710 Polyorthoester Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002685 Polyoxyl 35CastorOil Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 108010015078 Pregnancy-Associated alpha 2-Macroglobulins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000283080 Proboscidea <mammal> Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010060862 Prostate cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000000236 Prostatic Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010001267 Protein Subunits Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000002067 Protein Subunits Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 239000012083 RIPA buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 102000017143 RNA Polymerase I Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010013845 RNA Polymerase I Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000014450 RNA Polymerase III Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010078067 RNA Polymerase III Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000012980 RPMI-1640 medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 206010038389 Renal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010039085 Rhinitis allergic Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010039491 Ricin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000006146 Roswell Park Memorial Institute medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241000702670 Rotavirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 229920002684 Sepharose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000700584 Simplexvirus Species 0.000 description 1
- DWAQJAXMDSEUJJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium bisulfite Chemical compound [Na+].OS([O-])=O DWAQJAXMDSEUJJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 238000002105 Southern blotting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 241000256251 Spodoptera frugiperda Species 0.000 description 1
- 229920002472 Starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229930006000 Sucrose Natural products 0.000 description 1
- CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N Sucrose Chemical compound O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@@]1(CO)O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-L Sulfate Chemical compound [O-]S([O-])(=O)=O QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 230000006044 T cell activation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006052 T cell proliferation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005867 T cell response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 101150052863 THY1 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000013530 TOR Serine-Threonine Kinases Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010065917 TOR Serine-Threonine Kinases Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010043376 Tetanus Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 102000006601 Thymidine Kinase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020004440 Thymidine kinase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- AUYYCJSJGJYCDS-LBPRGKRZSA-N Thyrolar Chemical class IC1=CC(C[C@H](N)C(O)=O)=CC(I)=C1OC1=CC=C(O)C(I)=C1 AUYYCJSJGJYCDS-LBPRGKRZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 102000011923 Thyrotropin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010061174 Thyrotropin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920001615 Tragacanth Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 102100023132 Transcription factor Jun Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108700019146 Transgenes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010052779 Transplant rejections Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010067584 Type 1 diabetes mellitus Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000282458 Ursus sp. Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000251539 Vertebrata <Metazoa> Species 0.000 description 1
- 102100035071 Vimentin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010065472 Vimentin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- JXLYSJRDGCGARV-WWYNWVTFSA-N Vinblastine Natural products O=C(O[C@H]1[C@](O)(C(=O)OC)[C@@H]2N(C)c3c(cc(c(OC)c3)[C@]3(C(=O)OC)c4[nH]c5c(c4CCN4C[C@](O)(CC)C[C@H](C3)C4)cccc5)[C@@]32[C@H]2[C@@]1(CC)C=CCN2CC3)C JXLYSJRDGCGARV-WWYNWVTFSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940122803 Vinca alkaloid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000036142 Viral infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- VRGWBRLULZUWAJ-XFFXIZSCSA-N [(2s)-2-[(1r,3z,5s,8z,12z,15s)-5,17-dihydroxy-4,8,12,15-tetramethyl-16-oxo-18-bicyclo[13.3.0]octadeca-3,8,12,17-tetraenyl]propyl] acetate Chemical compound C1\C=C(C)/CC\C=C(C)/CC[C@H](O)\C(C)=C/C[C@@H]2C([C@@H](COC(C)=O)C)=C(O)C(=O)[C@]21C VRGWBRLULZUWAJ-XFFXIZSCSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003070 absorption delaying agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000001242 acetic acid derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229960004150 aciclovir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- MKUXAQIIEYXACX-UHFFFAOYSA-N aciclovir Chemical compound N1C(N)=NC(=O)C2=C1N(COCCO)C=N2 MKUXAQIIEYXACX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004480 active ingredient Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000443 aerosol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001042 affinity chromatography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004520 agglutination Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000783 alginic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010443 alginic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229920000615 alginic acid Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229960001126 alginic acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000004781 alginic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229940100198 alkylating agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000002168 alkylating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000009961 allergic asthma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000000172 allergic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000010105 allergic rhinitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101150087698 alpha gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- VREFGVBLTWBCJP-UHFFFAOYSA-N alprazolam Chemical compound C12=CC(Cl)=CC=C2N2C(C)=NN=C2CN=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 VREFGVBLTWBCJP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000004075 alteration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004873 anchoring Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000137 annealing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000008485 antagonism Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940045799 anthracyclines and related substance Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000002280 anti-androgenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940046836 anti-estrogen Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000001833 anti-estrogenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003432 anti-folate effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000340 anti-metabolite Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000259 anti-tumor effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000051 antiandrogen Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940127074 antifolate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940100197 antimetabolite Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000002256 antimetabolite Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002246 antineoplastic agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940041181 antineoplastic drug Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000003963 antioxidant agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000006708 antioxidants Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000009118 appropriate response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 208000010668 atopic eczema Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000003305 autocrine Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000000376 autoradiography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 208000022362 bacterial infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000003385 bacteriostatic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004888 barrier function Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000019445 benzyl alcohol Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000003833 bile salt Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940093761 bile salts Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229920000249 biocompatible polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000013060 biological fluid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960002685 biotin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000020958 biotin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000011616 biotin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007413 biotinylation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006287 biotinylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000740 bleeding effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960001561 bleomycin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- OYVAGSVQBOHSSS-UAPAGMARSA-O bleomycin A2 Chemical compound N([C@H](C(=O)N[C@H](C)[C@@H](O)[C@H](C)C(=O)N[C@@H]([C@H](O)C)C(=O)NCCC=1SC=C(N=1)C=1SC=C(N=1)C(=O)NCCC[S+](C)C)[C@@H](O[C@H]1[C@H]([C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](CO)O1)O[C@@H]1[C@H]([C@@H](OC(N)=O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1)O)C=1N=CNC=1)C(=O)C1=NC([C@H](CC(N)=O)NC[C@H](N)C(N)=O)=NC(N)=C1C OYVAGSVQBOHSSS-UAPAGMARSA-O 0.000 description 1
- 210000004369 blood Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000008280 blood Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000037396 body weight Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000000481 breast Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000009395 breeding Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001488 breeding effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000872 buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007853 buffer solution Substances 0.000 description 1
- DQXBYHZEEUGOBF-UHFFFAOYSA-N but-3-enoic acid;ethene Chemical compound C=C.OC(=O)CC=C DQXBYHZEEUGOBF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 210000004899 c-terminal region Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000001110 calcium chloride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910001628 calcium chloride Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000001506 calcium phosphate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000389 calcium phosphate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 235000011010 calcium phosphates Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229940127093 camptothecin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- VSJKWCGYPAHWDS-FQEVSTJZSA-N camptothecin Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C=C(CN3C4=CC5=C(C3=O)COC(=O)[C@]5(O)CC)C4=NC2=C1 VSJKWCGYPAHWDS-FQEVSTJZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000009566 cancer vaccine Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000001569 carbon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910002092 carbon dioxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000001768 cations Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000004113 cell culture Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000010261 cell growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000000170 cell membrane Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000006285 cell suspension Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000036755 cellular response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005754 cellular signaling Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005119 centrifugation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002738 chelating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000013330 chicken meat Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 210000004978 chinese hamster ovary cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960004926 chlorobutanol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960003405 ciprofloxacin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- DQLATGHUWYMOKM-UHFFFAOYSA-L cisplatin Chemical compound N[Pt](N)(Cl)Cl DQLATGHUWYMOKM-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 229960004316 cisplatin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000001860 citric acid derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000010367 cloning Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000975 co-precipitation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940110456 cocoa butter Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019868 cocoa butter Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000005515 coenzyme Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920001436 collagen Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229960002424 collagenase Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940075614 colloidal silicon dioxide Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000013329 compounding Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012141 concentrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000470 constituent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000001276 controlling effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007796 conventional method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008120 corn starch Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006071 cream Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000004748 cultured cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000030381 cutaneous melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229960004397 cyclophosphamide Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000016396 cytokine production Effects 0.000 description 1
- 108010057085 cytokine receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000003675 cytokine receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 230000009089 cytolysis Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001461 cytolytic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- OPTASPLRGRRNAP-UHFFFAOYSA-N cytosine Chemical class NC=1C=CNC(=O)N=1 OPTASPLRGRRNAP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 210000001151 cytotoxic T lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229940127089 cytotoxic agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000002254 cytotoxic agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000001934 delay Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004443 dendritic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000025729 dengue disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000368 destabilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003599 detergent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008121 dextrose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000005911 diet Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000037213 diet Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000029087 digestion Effects 0.000 description 1
- UGMCXQCYOVCMTB-UHFFFAOYSA-K dihydroxy(stearato)aluminium Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)O[Al](O)O UGMCXQCYOVCMTB-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 239000003085 diluting agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010790 dilution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012895 dilution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 206010013023 diphtheria Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000035475 disorder Diseases 0.000 description 1
- VSJKWCGYPAHWDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N dl-camptothecin Natural products C1=CC=C2C=C(CN3C4=CC5=C(C3=O)COC(=O)C5(O)CC)C4=NC2=C1 VSJKWCGYPAHWDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003534 dna topoisomerase inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960003668 docetaxel Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960004679 doxorubicin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000000890 drug combination Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241001493065 dsRNA viruses Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000000975 dye Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004520 electroporation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007920 enema Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940079360 enema for constipation Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000003623 enhancer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002532 enzyme inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960001904 epirubicin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000000328 estrogen antagonist Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000005038 ethylene vinyl acetate Substances 0.000 description 1
- VJJPUSNTGOMMGY-MRVIYFEKSA-N etoposide Chemical compound COC1=C(O)C(OC)=CC([C@@H]2C3=CC=4OCOC=4C=C3[C@@H](O[C@H]3[C@@H]([C@@H](O)[C@@H]4O[C@H](C)OC[C@H]4O3)O)[C@@H]3[C@@H]2C(OC3)=O)=C1 VJJPUSNTGOMMGY-MRVIYFEKSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960005420 etoposide Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 210000003527 eukaryotic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000029142 excretion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000835 fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000796 flavoring agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960004413 flucytosine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940124307 fluoroquinolone Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960002949 fluorouracil Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960002074 flutamide Drugs 0.000 description 1
- MKXKFYHWDHIYRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N flutamide Chemical compound CC(C)C(=O)NC1=CC=C([N+]([O-])=O)C(C(F)(F)F)=C1 MKXKFYHWDHIYRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004052 folic acid antagonist Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000013355 food flavoring agent Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000003599 food sweetener Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000005714 functional activity Effects 0.000 description 1
- VRGWBRLULZUWAJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N fusaproliferin Natural products C1C=C(C)CCC=C(C)CCC(O)C(C)=CCC2C(C(COC(C)=O)C)=C(O)C(=O)C21C VRGWBRLULZUWAJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IECPWNUMDGFDKC-MZJAQBGESA-M fusidate Chemical class O[C@@H]([C@@H]12)C[C@H]3\C(=C(/CCC=C(C)C)C([O-])=O)[C@@H](OC(C)=O)C[C@]3(C)[C@@]2(C)CC[C@@H]2[C@]1(C)CC[C@@H](O)[C@H]2C IECPWNUMDGFDKC-MZJAQBGESA-M 0.000 description 1
- 210000004475 gamma-delta t lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960002963 ganciclovir Drugs 0.000 description 1
- IRSCQMHQWWYFCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N ganciclovir Chemical compound O=C1NC(N)=NC2=C1N=CN2COC(CO)CO IRSCQMHQWWYFCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000000499 gel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007903 gelatin capsule Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001415 gene therapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002068 genetic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000008103 glucose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960003180 glutathione Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 102000006602 glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020004445 glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 125000005456 glyceride group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 101150028578 grp78 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229940029575 guanosine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940045808 haemophilus influenzae type b Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229910001385 heavy metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 210000002443 helper t lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000002672 hepatitis B Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000010284 hepatitis E Diseases 0.000 description 1
- SPSXSWRZQFPVTJ-ZQQKUFEYSA-N hepatitis b vaccine Chemical compound C([C@H](NC(=O)[C@H]([C@@H](C)O)NC(=O)[C@H]([C@@H](C)O)NC(=O)[C@H](CO)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1C2=CC=CC=C2NC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCSC)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC1N=CN=C1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H]([C@@H](C)O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(O)=O)C(=O)N1[C@@H](CCC1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)N[C@@H](C(C)C)C(=O)OC(=O)CNC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@H](C)NC(=O)[C@H]1N(CCC1)C(=O)[C@H](CC=1C=CC=CC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCCNC(N)=N)C1=CC=CC=C1 SPSXSWRZQFPVTJ-ZQQKUFEYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940124736 hepatitis-B vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 101150113423 hisD gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 210000003630 histaminocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000012510 hollow fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000013632 homeostatic process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000002744 homologous recombination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006801 homologous recombination Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000001050 hortel pimenta Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229960001101 ifosfamide Drugs 0.000 description 1
- HOMGKSMUEGBAAB-UHFFFAOYSA-N ifosfamide Chemical compound ClCCNP1(=O)OCCCN1CCCl HOMGKSMUEGBAAB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000003384 imaging method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003100 immobilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006058 immune tolerance Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000003119 immunoblot Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010166 immunofluorescence Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000017555 immunoglobulin mediated immune response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000016784 immunoglobulin production Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960003444 immunosuppressant agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940124589 immunosuppressive drug Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000001771 impaired effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007901 in situ hybridization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011534 incubation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003701 inert diluent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012678 infectious agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004968 inflammatory condition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001802 infusion Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007972 injectable composition Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002484 inorganic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910010272 inorganic material Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000010354 integration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960003130 interferon gamma Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 108040003610 interleukin-12 receptor activity proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000010253 intravenous injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960004768 irinotecan Drugs 0.000 description 1
- UWKQSNNFCGGAFS-XIFFEERXSA-N irinotecan Chemical compound C1=C2C(CC)=C3CN(C(C4=C([C@@](C(=O)OC4)(O)CC)C=4)=O)C=4C3=NC2=CC=C1OC(=O)N(CC1)CCC1N1CCCCC1 UWKQSNNFCGGAFS-XIFFEERXSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229930027917 kanamycin Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 229960000318 kanamycin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- SBUJHOSQTJFQJX-NOAMYHISSA-N kanamycin Chemical compound O[C@@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CN)O[C@@H]1O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O[C@@H]2[C@@H]([C@@H](N)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O2)O)[C@H](N)C[C@@H]1N SBUJHOSQTJFQJX-NOAMYHISSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229930182823 kanamycin A Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 201000010982 kidney cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000011005 laboratory method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008101 lactose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000787 lecithin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010445 lecithin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229940067606 lecithin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000001909 leucine group Chemical group [H]N(*)C(C(*)=O)C([H])([H])C(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 210000000265 leukocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000021633 leukocyte mediated immunity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001638 lipofection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000007270 liver cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000014018 liver neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000007774 longterm Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000314 lubricant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000329 lymphopenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002540 macrophage Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 235000019359 magnesium stearate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000014759 maintenance of location Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000004792 malaria Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000000594 mannitol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010355 mannitol Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002609 medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000001441 melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- SGDBTWWWUNNDEQ-LBPRGKRZSA-N melphalan Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC1=CC=C(N(CCCl)CCCl)C=C1 SGDBTWWWUNNDEQ-LBPRGKRZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001924 melphalan Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960000485 methotrexate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000002496 methyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- STZCRXQWRGQSJD-GEEYTBSJSA-M methyl orange Chemical compound [Na+].C1=CC(N(C)C)=CC=C1\N=N\C1=CC=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C=C1 STZCRXQWRGQSJD-GEEYTBSJSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 229940012189 methyl orange Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000010270 methyl p-hydroxybenzoate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229960001047 methyl salicylate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019813 microcrystalline cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008108 microcrystalline cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940016286 microcrystalline cellulose Drugs 0.000 description 1
- VFKZTMPDYBFSTM-GUCUJZIJSA-N mitolactol Chemical compound BrC[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)CBr VFKZTMPDYBFSTM-GUCUJZIJSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229950010913 mitolactol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000003607 modifier Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001823 molecular biology technique Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003068 molecular probe Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012544 monitoring process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001459 mortal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002324 mouth wash Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940051866 mouthwash Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 201000006417 multiple sclerosis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000010805 mumps infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 231100000219 mutagenic Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 230000003505 mutagenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 101150008049 mx gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000007922 nasal spray Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006218 nasal suppository Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000000822 natural killer cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000002501 natural regulatory T cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000006199 nebulizer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960004927 neomycin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000000346 nonvolatile oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002853 nucleic acid probe Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000016709 nutrition Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 201000002575 ocular melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000006384 oligomerization reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003606 oligomerizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002751 oligonucleotide probe Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002894 organic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000002902 organometallic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 210000001672 ovary Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- QUANRIQJNFHVEU-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxirane;propane-1,2,3-triol Chemical compound C1CO1.OCC(O)CO QUANRIQJNFHVEU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000004806 packaging method and process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960001592 paclitaxel Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000036961 partial effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000010412 perfusion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002974 pharmacogenomic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000012071 phase Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960003742 phenol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- QGVLYPPODPLXMB-QXYKVGAMSA-N phorbol Natural products C[C@@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@]2(O)[C@H]([C@H]3C=C(CO)C[C@@]4(O)[C@H](C=C(C)C4=O)[C@@]13O)C2(C)C QGVLYPPODPLXMB-QXYKVGAMSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 235000021317 phosphate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000003013 phosphoric acid derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- BZQFBWGGLXLEPQ-REOHCLBHSA-N phosphoserine Chemical group OC(=O)[C@@H](N)COP(O)(O)=O BZQFBWGGLXLEPQ-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000004962 physiological condition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002504 physiological saline solution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006187 pill Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000003058 platinum compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229920001200 poly(ethylene-vinyl acetate) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000747 poly(lactic acid) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 230000008488 polyadenylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000008389 polyethoxylated castor oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004633 polyglycolic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004626 polylactic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920005862 polyol Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 150000003077 polyols Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 210000001236 prokaryotic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229930185346 proliferin Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 230000002035 prolonged effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001737 promoting effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003380 propellant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004952 protein activity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002797 proteolythic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002285 radioactive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000003127 radioimmunoassay Methods 0.000 description 1
- ZAHRKKWIAAJSAO-UHFFFAOYSA-N rapamycin Natural products COCC(O)C(=C/C(C)C(=O)CC(OC(=O)C1CCCCN1C(=O)C(=O)C2(O)OC(CC(OC)C(=CC=CC=CC(C)CC(C)C(=O)C)C)CCC2C)C(C)CC3CCC(O)C(C3)OC)C ZAHRKKWIAAJSAO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000009257 reactivity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010188 recombinant method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000022532 regulation of transcription, DNA-dependent Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008439 repair process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003252 repetitive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011160 research Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004043 responsiveness Effects 0.000 description 1
- 108091008146 restriction endonucleases Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000001177 retroviral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 206010039073 rheumatoid arthritis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000005404 rubella Diseases 0.000 description 1
- CVHZOJJKTDOEJC-UHFFFAOYSA-N saccharin Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(=O)NS(=O)(=O)C2=C1 CVHZOJJKTDOEJC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940081974 saccharin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019204 saccharin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000901 saccharin and its Na,K and Ca salt Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003345 scintillation counting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000006152 selective media Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013207 serial dilution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000405 serological effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 102000035025 signaling receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108091005475 signaling receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229960002930 sirolimus Drugs 0.000 description 1
- QFJCIRLUMZQUOT-HPLJOQBZSA-N sirolimus Chemical compound C1C[C@@H](O)[C@H](OC)C[C@@H]1C[C@@H](C)[C@H]1OC(=O)[C@@H]2CCCCN2C(=O)C(=O)[C@](O)(O2)[C@H](C)CC[C@H]2C[C@H](OC)/C(C)=C/C=C/C=C/[C@@H](C)C[C@@H](C)C(=O)[C@H](OC)[C@H](O)/C(C)=C/[C@@H](C)C(=O)C1 QFJCIRLUMZQUOT-HPLJOQBZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000002741 site-directed mutagenesis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000003491 skin Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 201000003708 skin melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- NLJMYIDDQXHKNR-UHFFFAOYSA-K sodium citrate Chemical compound O.O.[Na+].[Na+].[Na+].[O-]C(=O)CC(O)(CC([O-])=O)C([O-])=O NLJMYIDDQXHKNR-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 238000002415 sodium dodecyl sulfate polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000010267 sodium hydrogen sulphite Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000007790 solid phase Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006104 solid solution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000600 sorbitol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011895 specific detection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003393 splenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004988 splenocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000007921 spray Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000006641 stabilisation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011105 stabilization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000087 stabilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010561 standard procedure Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008107 starch Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000019698 starch Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000001954 sterilising effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004659 sterilization and disinfection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 1
- 108091007196 stromelysin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000005720 sucrose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000000346 sugar Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000005846 sugar alcohols Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 150000008163 sugars Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000002511 suppository base Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004094 surface-active agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002459 sustained effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003765 sweetening agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007910 systemic administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229940037128 systemic glucocorticoids Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960001603 tamoxifen Drugs 0.000 description 1
- RCINICONZNJXQF-MZXODVADSA-N taxol Chemical compound O([C@@H]1[C@@]2(C[C@@H](C(C)=C(C2(C)C)[C@H](C([C@]2(C)[C@@H](O)C[C@H]3OC[C@]3([C@H]21)OC(C)=O)=O)OC(=O)C)OC(=O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](NC(=O)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)O)C(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 RCINICONZNJXQF-MZXODVADSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002381 testicular Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940022511 therapeutic cancer vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- RTKIYNMVFMVABJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L thimerosal Chemical compound [Na+].CC[Hg]SC1=CC=CC=C1C([O-])=O RTKIYNMVFMVABJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 229940033663 thimerosal Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000003161 three-hybrid assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000005495 thyroid hormone Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940036555 thyroid hormone Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960003087 tioguanine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- MNRILEROXIRVNJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N tioguanine Chemical compound N1C(N)=NC(=S)C2=NC=N[C]21 MNRILEROXIRVNJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940044693 topoisomerase inhibitor Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000002463 transducing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001131 transforming effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013519 translation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011269 treatment regimen Methods 0.000 description 1
- QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H tricalcium bis(phosphate) Chemical compound [Ca+2].[Ca+2].[Ca+2].[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O.[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H 0.000 description 1
- HRXKRNGNAMMEHJ-UHFFFAOYSA-K trisodium citrate Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[Na+].[O-]C(=O)CC(O)(CC([O-])=O)C([O-])=O HRXKRNGNAMMEHJ-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 229940038773 trisodium citrate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 201000008827 tuberculosis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000004881 tumor cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000003160 two-hybrid assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 108091052247 type I cytokine receptor family Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000042286 type I cytokine receptor family Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 208000027930 type IV hypersensitivity disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000701161 unidentified adenovirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 238000001291 vacuum drying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000009777 vacuum freeze-drying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003981 vehicle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000035899 viability Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000005048 vimentin Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960003048 vinblastine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- JXLYSJRDGCGARV-XQKSVPLYSA-N vincaleukoblastine Chemical compound C([C@@H](C[C@]1(C(=O)OC)C=2C(=CC3=C([C@]45[C@H]([C@@]([C@H](OC(C)=O)[C@]6(CC)C=CCN([C@H]56)CC4)(O)C(=O)OC)N3C)C=2)OC)C[C@@](C2)(O)CC)N2CCC2=C1NC1=CC=CC=C21 JXLYSJRDGCGARV-XQKSVPLYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960004355 vindesine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- UGGWPQSBPIFKDZ-KOTLKJBCSA-N vindesine Chemical compound C([C@@H](C[C@]1(C(=O)OC)C=2C(=CC3=C([C@]45[C@H]([C@@]([C@H](O)[C@]6(CC)C=CCN([C@H]56)CC4)(O)C(N)=O)N3C)C=2)OC)C[C@@](C2)(O)CC)N2CCC2=C1N=C1[C]2C=CC=C1 UGGWPQSBPIFKDZ-KOTLKJBCSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GBABOYUKABKIAF-GHYRFKGUSA-N vinorelbine Chemical compound C1N(CC=2C3=CC=CC=C3NC=22)CC(CC)=C[C@H]1C[C@]2(C(=O)OC)C1=CC([C@]23[C@H]([C@]([C@H](OC(C)=O)[C@]4(CC)C=CCN([C@H]34)CC2)(O)C(=O)OC)N2C)=C2C=C1OC GBABOYUKABKIAF-GHYRFKGUSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960002066 vinorelbine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000011534 wash buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005406 washing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008215 water for injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012130 whole-cell lysate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940075420 xanthine Drugs 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
- C07K14/435—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
- C07K14/705—Receptors; Cell surface antigens; Cell surface determinants
- C07K14/715—Receptors; Cell surface antigens; Cell surface determinants for cytokines; for lymphokines; for interferons
- C07K14/7155—Receptors; Cell surface antigens; Cell surface determinants for cytokines; for lymphokines; for interferons for interleukins [IL]
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P29/00—Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P35/00—Antineoplastic agents
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K16/00—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies
- C07K16/18—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans
- C07K16/24—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against cytokines, lymphokines or interferons
- C07K16/244—Interleukins [IL]
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K16/00—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies
- C07K16/18—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans
- C07K16/28—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants
- C07K16/2866—Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants against receptors for cytokines, lymphokines, interferons
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Q—MEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
- C12Q1/00—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
- C12Q1/68—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving nucleic acids
- C12Q1/6876—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes
- C12Q1/6883—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes for diseases caused by alterations of genetic material
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Q—MEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
- C12Q1/00—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
- C12Q1/68—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving nucleic acids
- C12Q1/6876—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes
- C12Q1/6883—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes for diseases caused by alterations of genetic material
- C12Q1/6886—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes for diseases caused by alterations of genetic material for cancer
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01N—INVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
- G01N33/00—Investigating or analysing materials by specific methods not covered by groups G01N1/00 - G01N31/00
- G01N33/48—Biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Haemocytometers
- G01N33/50—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing
- G01N33/5005—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing involving human or animal cells
- G01N33/5008—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing involving human or animal cells for testing or evaluating the effect of chemical or biological compounds, e.g. drugs, cosmetics
- G01N33/5044—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing involving human or animal cells for testing or evaluating the effect of chemical or biological compounds, e.g. drugs, cosmetics involving specific cell types
- G01N33/5047—Cells of the immune system
- G01N33/505—Cells of the immune system involving T-cells
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A01—AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
- A01K—ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; AVICULTURE; APICULTURE; PISCICULTURE; FISHING; REARING OR BREEDING ANIMALS, NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; NEW BREEDS OF ANIMALS
- A01K2217/00—Genetically modified animals
- A01K2217/05—Animals comprising random inserted nucleic acids (transgenic)
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A01—AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
- A01K—ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; AVICULTURE; APICULTURE; PISCICULTURE; FISHING; REARING OR BREEDING ANIMALS, NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; NEW BREEDS OF ANIMALS
- A01K2267/00—Animals characterised by purpose
- A01K2267/03—Animal model, e.g. for test or diseases
- A01K2267/035—Animal model for multifactorial diseases
- A01K2267/0387—Animal model for diseases of the immune system
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K39/00—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
- A61K2039/505—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising antibodies
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K2317/00—Immunoglobulins specific features
- C07K2317/70—Immunoglobulins specific features characterized by effect upon binding to a cell or to an antigen
- C07K2317/76—Antagonist effect on antigen, e.g. neutralization or inhibition of binding
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Q—MEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
- C12Q2600/00—Oligonucleotides characterized by their use
- C12Q2600/158—Expression markers
Definitions
- the present invention relates to methods for regulating T cell function in a subject, particularly effector T cell activity.
- sequence listing is submitted concurrently with the specification as a text file via EFS-Web, in compliance with the American Standard Code for Information Interchange (ASCII), with a file name of 397057SEQLIST.txt, a creation date of Nov. 16, 2010, and a size of 61 KB.
- ASCII American Standard Code for Information Interchange
- the sequence listing filed via EFS-Web is part of the specification and is hereby incorporated in its entirety by reference herein.
- the immune system provides the human body with a means to recognize and defend itself against microorganisms, viruses, and substances recognized as foreign and potentially harmful.
- Classical immune responses are initiated when antigen-presenting cells present an antigen to CD4+ T helper (Th) lymphocytes resulting in T cell activation, proliferation, and differentiation of effector T lymphocytes.
- Th T helper
- na ⁇ ve T cells differentiate into Th1 and Th2 cells with differing functions.
- Th1 cells produce interferon gamma (IFN- ⁇ ) and interleukin 2 (IL-2) (both associated with cell-mediated immune responses).
- IFN- ⁇ interferon gamma
- IL-2 interleukin 2
- Th1 cells play a role in immune responses commonly involved in the rejection of foreign tissue grafts as well as many autoimmune diseases.
- Th2 cells produce cytokines such as interleukin-4 (IL-4), and are associated with antibody-mediated immune responses such as those commonly involved in allergies and allergic inflammatory responses such as allergic rhinitis and asthma.
- IL-4 interleukin-4
- Th2 cells may also contribute to the rejection of foreign grafts.
- this immune response is desirable, for example, in defending the body against bacterial or viral infection, inhibiting the proliferation of cancerous cells and the like.
- effector T cells are undesirable, e.g., in a graft recipient.
- T regulatory cells are responsible for the induction and maintenance of immunological tolerance. Regulatory T cells actively suppress the proliferation and cytokine production of Th1, Th2, or na ⁇ ve cells which have been stimulated in culture with an activating signal (e.g., antigen and antigen presenting cells or with a signal that mimics antigen in the context of MHC, e.g., anti-CD3 antibody, plus anti-CD28 antibody).
- an activating signal e.g., antigen and antigen presenting cells or with a signal that mimics antigen in the context of MHC, e.g., anti-CD3 antibody, plus anti-CD28 antibody.
- the receptor for Interleukin 35 (IL-35) is provided.
- the Interleukin-35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interleukin-12R ⁇ 2 receptor (Il12rb2) and the gp130 receptor (also known as Interleukin-6 signal transducer, Il6st).
- IL-35R comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interleukin-12R ⁇ 2 receptor (Il12rb2) and the gp130 receptor (also known as Interleukin-6 signal transducer, Il6st).
- Various compositions comprising the IL-35R complex, along with polynucleotides encoding the same and kits and methods for the detection of the same are provided.
- Methods of modulating the activity of IL-35R or modulating effector T cell functions employ various IL-35R antagonists and agonists that modulate the activity of the IL-35R complex and, in some embodiments, modulate effector T cell function. Further provided are methods for screening for IL-35R binding agents and for IL-35R modulating agents. Various methods of treatment are further provided.
- FIG. 1 demonstrates that T-cells that lack both the Interluekin12R ⁇ 2 receptor (IL12R ⁇ 2) and the gp130 receptor are completely resistant to suppression mediated by IL-35 or iTr35, an induced regulatory T cell population that suppresses via IL-35.
- IL12R ⁇ 2 Interluekin12R ⁇ 2 receptor
- iTr35 Interluekin12R ⁇ 2 receptor
- FIG. 2 demonstrates that IL35R deficient T conv are resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression in vivo.
- Homeostatic expansion was monitored by i.v. injection of Thy1.2 + T conv cells from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130 ⁇ T (gp130 deficient in T cells), Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35RAT (gp130 ⁇ T /Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ ) mice alone or with Thy1.1 + iT R 35 cells (as regulatory cells) into Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice. Seven days after transfer, splenic T cell numbers were determined by flow cytometry.
- mice received CD4 + and CD8 + T cells from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130 ⁇ T , Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35R ⁇ T mice alone or with iT R 35 cells via the tail vein on day ⁇ 1 of the experiment. On day 0, all were injected with 120,000 B16 cells i.d. in the right flank. Tumor diameter was measured daily for 14 days and is reported as mm 3 . Data represent the mean ⁇ SEM of 5-12 mice per group.
- FIG. 3 demonstrates that IL35 is a target of the IL35 signaling pathway.
- A T conv purified by FACS from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130 ⁇ T (gp130 deficient in T cells), Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35R ⁇ T (gp130 ⁇ T Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ ) mice were activated with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads for 18 hours in the presence of IL-35. RNA was extracted, cDNA generated and qPCR performed. Relative Ebi3 (left panel) and Il12a (right panel) mRNA expression.
- T conv from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130 ⁇ T , Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35R ⁇ T mice were activated in the presence of IL-35 or control protein at 25% of total culture volume, for 72 hours to generate iT R 35 or iT R con cells, respectively.
- Cells were re-purified and mixed at indicated ratios (T conv : suppressor) and proliferation was determined by [ 3 H]-thymidine incorporation.
- Counts per minute of T conv cells activated alone were 29,000-48,000 (b). Data represent the mean ⁇ SEM of 3-5 independent experiments.
- the receptor for Interleukin 35 (IL-35) is provided.
- the Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interluekin12R ⁇ 2 receptor (IL12R ⁇ 2) and the gp130 receptor.
- the Interleukin 35 receptor refers to any intramolecular complex or single molecule comprising at least one gp130 polypeptide component or biologically active variant or fragment thereof and at least one IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide component or biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
- gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 associate via a non-covalent association.
- the IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130 components may be associated with one another either covalently or non-covalently.
- gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 can be co-expressed as a fusion protein.
- IL-35R complexes comprise an active variant or fragment of gp130 and/or an active variant or fragment of IL12R ⁇ 2 and will retain at least one activity of the IL-35R complex.
- biological activity of IL-35R refers to one or more of the biological activities of IL-35R, including but not limited to, (1) interacting with its ligand, IL-35; (2) activating any of the STAT pathways including the STAT1 and/or STAT4 pathways; (3) IL-35 dependent suppression of effector T-cell function, including for example, suppression of proliferation, cytokine secretion and/or differentiation; and/or (4) autocrine induction of IL-35 expression by IL-35.
- Such assays can be found, for example, in Collison et al. (2007) Nature 450:566-569; Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101.
- Interleukin 35 refers to any intramolecular complex or single molecule comprising at least one EBI3 polypeptide component and at least one p35 polypeptide component. See, for example, International Patent Application No. PCT/US2007/079310, filed Sep. 24, 2007, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety.
- EBI3 and p35 are known in the art.
- the human EBI3 gene encodes a protein of about 33 kDa. The protein shares about 27% sequence identity to the p40 subunit of human IL12. Nucleic acid and amino acid sequences for EBI3 are known.
- IL-35 encompasses naturally occurring variants of IL-35, e.g., splice variants, allelic variants, and other isoforms. The term also encompasses fragments or variants of a native IL-35 such that the active variants and fragment continue to bind and allow for the activation of IL-35R.
- an IL-35R complex can be encoded on a single polynucleotide.
- a polynucleotide comprising a nucleotide sequence encoding an Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex is provided and comprises a first sequence encoding the gp130 polypeptide or an active fragment or variant thereof; and a second sequence encoding the IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or an active fragment or variant thereof, wherein said encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex.
- the IL-35R complex is encoded on distinct polynucleotides.
- a mixture of recombinant expression constructs encoding the various components of the IL-35R complex are further provided.
- IL12R ⁇ 2 receptor IL12R ⁇ 2
- IL-12R-beta2 can be used interchangeably and refer to a family of cell surface receptors which can homodimerize or heterodimerize and display interleukin receptor activity and have now been shown herein to be a subunit of the IL-35R complex.
- Non-limiting examples of IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides comprise the human IL12R ⁇ 2 polynucleotide as set forth in SEQ ID NO:4, 5, and 6 (from GenBank Accession No. NM — 001559.2) and can be found in GenBank Accession No. P40189.
- IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides comprise a variety of conserved structural motifs. For ease of reference, such motifs will be discussed as they relate to the human IL12R ⁇ 2 isoform 1 which is set forth in SEQ ID NO:6.
- IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides comprise an extracellular domain (from about amino acids 24-522 of SEQ ID NO:6); a transmembrane domain (from about amino acids 623-643 of SEQ ID NO:3), and an intercellular domain (from about amino acids 644-862 of SEQ ID NO:6).
- Additional conserved domains and motifs that have been characterized in the IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides include a signal peptide (from about amino acids 1-23 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III I domain (from about amino acids 124-218 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 2 domain (from about amino acids 224-316 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 3 domain (from about amino acids 317-415 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 4 domain (from about amino acids 420-517 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 5 domain (from about amino acids 521-617 of SEQ ID NO:6), a motif involved with STAT4 binding (from about amino acids 796-801 of SEQ ID NO:6), a WSXWS motif (from about amino acids 305-309 of SEQ ID NO:6) which appears to be involved in proper protein folding and thereby efficient intracellular transport and cell-surface receptor binding, and
- IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention.
- Such active variants and fragments will contain an IL-35R receptor activity when complexed with the gp130 partner.
- Variants of IL12R ⁇ 2 are known including, but not limited to, an alternative sequence from aa 650-659 of SEQ ID NO:6 replacing VFVLLAALRP with RRHSCPWTGS; an alternative sequence from aa 660-862 of SEQ ID NO:6 is missing; the Rat aa 149 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with Q; the I at aa 185 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with V; the T at aa 201 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with I; the R at aa 313 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with G; the G at aa 420 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with R; the Q at aa 426 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with H; the G at aa 465 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with D; the A at aa 625 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with V; the H at aa 720 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with R; the
- fragments of IL12R ⁇ 2 are employed which comprise the extracellular domain of the IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant of the extracellular domain of IL12R ⁇ 2.
- Such biologically active variants and fragments of the IL12R ⁇ 2 extracellular domain will retain the ability to complex with the gp130 binding partner's extracellular domain and upon complex formation, the gp130/IL12R ⁇ 2 complex will interact with the IL-35 ligand. Methods to assay for such binding are known.
- the IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide comprises the amino acid sequence as shown in SEQ ID NO:6 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
- polynucleotides comprising the nucleotide sequence encoding a IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide including the nucleotide sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:4 or 5 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
- gp130 Interleukin-6-receptor subunit beta
- IL-6R-beta Interleukin-6-signal transducer
- membrane glycoprotein 130 CDW130
- Oncostatin-M receptor alpha subunit can be used interchangeably and refer to a family of cell surface receptors which can homodimerize or heterodimerize and display interleukin receptor activity and have now been shown herein to be a subunit of the IL-35R complex.
- Non-limiting examples of gp130 polypeptides comprising the human gp130 polynucleotide and polypeptide are set forth in SEQ ID NOs: 1, 2, and 3 (GenBank Accession No. NP — 002184.2) or also in GenBank Accession No. P40189.
- the gp130 polypeptide comprises a variety of conserved structural motifs and belongs to the type I cytokine receptor family. For ease of reference, such motifs will be discussed as they relate to the human gp130 isoform 1 which is set forth in SEQ ID NO:3.
- gp130 polypeptides comprise an extracellular domain (from about amino acids 23-619 of SEQ ID NO:3); a transmembrane domain (from about amino acids 260-641 of SEQ ID NO:3), and an intercellular domain (from about amino acids 642-918 of SEQ ID NO:3).
- Additional conserved domains and motifs have been characterized in the gp130 polypeptides include a signal peptide (from about amino acids 1-22 of SEQ ID NO:3), an IG-like C2-type domain (from about amino acids 26-120 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III I domain (from about amino acids 125-216 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 2 domain (from about amino acids 222-321 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 3 domain (from about amino acids 326-418 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 4 domain (from about amino acids 423-514 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 5 domain (from about amino acids 518-610 of SEQ ID NO:3), a WSXWS motif (from about amino acids 310-314 of SEQ ID NO:3) which appears to be involved in proper protein folding and thereby efficient intracellular transport and cell-surface receptor binding, a Box 1 motif (
- Glycosylation can occur at amino acid positions 43, 83, 131, 157, 227, 379, 383, 553, 564 of SEQ ID NO:3.
- Modified phosphoserine residues can occur at amino acids 667, 782, 820, and 829 of SEQ ID NO:3.
- Disulfide bonds can occur between amino acids 28 and 54, 48 and 103, 134 and 144, 172 and 182, and 458 and 466 of SEQ ID NO:3.
- variants and fragments of the gp130 polypeptide can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention. Such active variants and fragments will continue to retain an IL-35R activity when complexed with the IL12R ⁇ 2 partner.
- variants and fragments of gp130 polypeptides and polynucleotides are known including, but not limited to, an alternative sequence from aa 325-329 of SEQ ID NO:3 replacing RPSKA with NIASF; an alternative sequence from aa 330-918 of SEQ ID NO:3 is missing; the T at aa 415 of SEQ ID NO:3 is replaced with I; or the S at aa 782 of SEQ ID NO:3 is replaced with A.
- fragments of the gp130 are employed which comprise the extracellular domain of the gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant of the extracellular domain of gp130.
- Such biologically active variants and fragments of the extracellular domain of gp130 will retain the ability to complex with the IL12R ⁇ 2 binding partner's extracellular domain and upon complex formation, the gp130/IL12R ⁇ 2 complex can interact with the IL-35 ligand. Methods to assay for such binding are known.
- the gp130 polypeptide comprises the amino acid sequence as shown in SEQ ID NO:3 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
- polynucleotides comprising the nucleotide sequence encoding a gp130 polypeptide including the nucleotide sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:1 or 2 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof
- Fragments and variants of the polynucleotides encoding the gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention.
- fragment is intended a portion of the polynucleotide and hence the protein encoded thereby or a portion of the polypeptide.
- Fragments of a polynucleotide may encode protein fragments that retain the biological activity of the native protein and hence have IL-35R activity when complexed with the appropriate binding partner.
- fragments of a polynucleotide may range from at least about 20 nucleotides, about 50 nucleotides, about 100 nucleotides, about 150, about 200, about 250, about 300, about 350, about 400, about 450, about 500, about 550, about 600 and up to the full-length polynucleotide encoding the gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide.
- a fragment of a polynucleotide that encodes a biologically active portion of a gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide will encode at least 15, 25, 30, 50, 100, 150, 200, or 250 contiguous amino acids, or up to the total number of amino acids present in a full-length gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide.
- a biologically active portion of a gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide can be prepared by isolating a portion of one of the polynucleotides encoding the portion of the gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide and expressing the encoded portion of the polypeptide (e.g., by recombinant expression in vitro), and assessing the activity of the portion of the gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide.
- Polynucleotides that encode fragments of a gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide can comprise nucleotide sequence comprising at least 16, 20, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, 800, 900, 1,000, 1,100, 1,200, 1,300, or 1,400 nucleotides, or up to the number of nucleotides present in a full-length gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 nucleotide sequence disclosed herein.
- Variant sequences have a high degree of sequence similarity.
- conservative variants include those sequences that, because of the degeneracy of the genetic code, encode the amino acid sequence of one of the gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides.
- Variants such as these can be identified with the use of well-known molecular biology techniques, as, for example, polymerase chain reaction (PCR) and hybridization techniques.
- Variant polynucleotides also include synthetically derived nucleotide sequences, such as those generated, for example, by using site-directed mutagenesis but which still encode a gp130 or a IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide.
- variants of a particular polynucleotide will have at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity to that particular polynucleotide as determined by sequence alignment programs and parameters described elsewhere herein.
- Variants of a particular polynucleotide can also be evaluated by comparison of the percent sequence identity between the polypeptide encoded by a variant polynucleotide and the polypeptide encoded by the reference polynucleotide.
- the percent sequence identity between the two encoded polypeptides is at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity.
- variant protein is intended a protein derived from the native protein by deletion (so-called truncation) or addition of one or more amino acids to the N-terminal and/or C-terminal end of the native protein; deletion or addition of one or more amino acids at one or more sites in the native protein; or substitution of one or more amino acids at one or more sites in the native protein.
- variant proteins are biologically active, that is they continue to possess the desired biological activity of the native protein, that is, IL-35R activity. Such variants may result from, for example, genetic polymorphism or from human manipulation.
- Biologically active variants of a gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides will have at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity to the amino acid sequence for the native protein as determined by sequence alignment programs and parameters described elsewhere herein.
- a biologically active variant of a protein may differ from that protein by as few as 1-15 amino acid residues, as few as 1-10, such as 6-10, as few as 5, as few as 4, 3, 2, or even 1 amino acid residue.
- Proteins may be altered in various ways including amino acid substitutions, deletions, truncations, and insertions. Methods for such manipulations are generally known in the art. For example, amino acid sequence variants of the gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 proteins can be prepared by mutations in the DNA. Methods for mutagenesis and nucleotide sequence alterations are well known in the art. See, for example, Kunkel (1985) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 82:488-492; Kunkel et al. (1987) Methods in Enzymol. 154:367-382; U.S. Pat. No. 4,873,192; Walker and Gaastra, eds.
- the polynucleotides used in the invention can include the naturally occurring sequences, the “native” sequences, as well as mutant forms.
- the proteins used in the methods of the invention encompass naturally occurring proteins as well as variations and modified forms thereof. Such variants will continue to possess the ability to implement a recombination event.
- the mutations made in the polynucleotide encoding the variant polypeptide should not place the sequence out of reading frame, and/or create complementary regions that could produce secondary mRNA structure. See, EP Patent Application Publication No. 75,444.
- deletions, insertions, and substitutions of the protein sequences encompassed herein are not expected to produce radical changes in the characteristics of the protein. However, when it is difficult to predict the exact effect of the substitution, deletion, or insertion in advance of doing so, one skilled in the art will appreciate that the effect will be evaluated by routine screening assays.
- Variant polynucleotides and proteins also encompass sequences and proteins derived from a mutagenic and recombinogenic procedure such as DNA shuffling. With such a procedure, one or more different gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 coding sequences can be manipulated to create a new gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides possessing the desired properties.
- libraries of recombinant polynucleotides are generated from a population of related sequence polynucleotides comprising sequence regions that have substantial sequence identity and can be homologously recombined in vitro or in vivo. Strategies for such DNA shuffling are known in the art. See, for example, Stemmer (1994) Proc. Natl. Acad.
- the term “modulating” includes “inducing”, “inhibiting”, “potentiating”, “elevating”, “increasing”, “decreasing” or the like. Each of these terms denote a quantitative difference between two states and in particular, refer to at least a statistically significant difference between the two states.
- IL-35R agonist refers to an agent which potentiates, induces or otherwise enhances one or more of the biological properties of the IL-35R complex.
- the activity increases by a statistically significant amount including, for example, an increase of at least about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 95% or 100% of the activity of the IL-35R complex compared to an appropriate control.
- IL-35R antagonist refers to an agent which reduces, inhibits, or otherwise diminishes one or more of the biological activities of the IL-35R complex.
- Antagonism using the IL-35R antagonist does not necessarily indicate a total elimination of the IL-35R activity. Instead, the activity could decrease by a statistically significant amount including, for example, a decrease of at least about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 95% or 100% of the activity of the IL-35R complex compared to an appropriate control.
- an IL-35R specific modulating agent modulates the biological activity of IL-35R by a statically significant amount (i.e., at least 5%, 10%, 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 100% or greater) and the agent does not modulate the biological activity of any monomeric subunits, homodimeric complexes or non-IL-35R heterodimeric complexes which comprise either IL12R ⁇ 2 or gp130 by a statistically significant amount (i.e., the activity is modulated by less than 5%, 4%, 3%, 2% or 1%).
- An IL-35R specific modulating agent may or may not be an IL-35R specific binding agent.
- the IL-35R modulating agent comprises a soluble IL-35R complex.
- a soluble complex is an IL-35R.
- a “soluble IL-35R complex” comprises an IL-35R polypeptide that is incapable of anchoring itself in a membrane.
- Such soluble IL-35R polypeptides include, for example, a complex of gp130 and/or IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptides that lack a sufficient portion of their membrane spanning domain to anchor the IL-35R to the membrane or such polypeptides are modified such that the membrane spanning domain is non-functional.
- a soluble fragment of a gp130 polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of gp130, including a fragment of the extracellular domain that is at least 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 90, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 590 or greater consecutive amino acids of gp130.
- a soluble fragment of an IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of IL12R ⁇ 2, including a fragment of the extracellular domain that is at least 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 90, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 495 or greater consecutive amino acids of IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the soluble IL-35R complex binds IL-35.
- the extracellular domains of gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 that are present in the soluble form of the IL-35R complex share at least 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% to the amino acid sequence or the polynucleotide sequences as set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6.
- the soluble IL-35R complex find further use in stabilizing IL-35 (increasing half-life) or acting to concentrate IL-35.
- a soluble IL-35R complex can additionally include a second moiety.
- the second moiety can be any chemical compound.
- the second moiety adds in the detection of the soluble complex or promotes the overall solubility of the complex.
- moieties include, but are not limited to, an immunoglobulin chain, a GST, Lex-A or MBP polypeptide sequence.
- a fusion protein can includes at least a fragment of an IL-35R complex, which is capable of binding IL-35, wherein the IL-35R complex comprises a soluble fragment of a gp130 (e.g., a fragment of gp130 comprising the extracellular domain of gp130) and a soluble fragment of IL12R ⁇ 2 (e.g., a fragment of IL12R ⁇ 2 comprising the extracellular domain of IL12R ⁇ 2) wherein at least one of the gp130 fragment, the IL12R ⁇ 2 fragment, or both are fused to a second moiety.
- the IL-35R complex comprises a soluble fragment of a gp130 (e.g., a fragment of gp130 comprising the extracellular domain of gp130) and a soluble fragment of IL12R ⁇ 2 (e.g., a fragment of IL12R ⁇ 2 comprising the extracellular domain of IL12R ⁇ 2) wherein at least one of the g
- the second moiety comprises an immunoglobulin chain, an Fc fragment (CH 2 , hinge, CH 3 constant region domains), a heavy chain constant region domain of the various isotypes, including: IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4, IgM, IgA1, IgA2, IgD, and IgE).
- a soluble form of the IL-35R complex can be generated using various protein motifs that assist in complex formation.
- One such motif comprises a leucine zipper motif.
- Leucine zipper domains are peptides that promote oligomerization of the polypeptides in which they are found.
- Leucine zippers were originally identified in several DNA-binding polypeptides (Landschulz et al. (1988) Science 240:1759), and have since been found in a variety of different polypeptides.
- the known leucine zippers are naturally occurring peptides and derivatives thereof that dimerize or trimerize.
- the zipper domain (also referred to herein as an oligomerizing, or oligomer-forming, domain) comprises a repetitive heptad repeat, often with four or five leucine residues interspersed with other amino acids.
- leucine zippers and preparation of oligomers using leucine zippers are well known in the art. Any other method which assists in the stabilization of the soluble complex can be employed.
- a soluble IL-35R complex can be encoded on a single polynucleotide.
- a polynucleotide comprising a nucleotide sequence encoding a soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex is provides and comprise a first sequence encoding the extracellular domain of gp130, an active fragment or variant thereof; and a second sequence encoding the extracellular domain of IL12R ⁇ 2, active fragment or variant thereof, the encoded soluble polypeptide complex bind IL-35.
- the soluble IL-35R complex is encoded on distinct polynucleotides.
- a “specific modulating agent” can comprise an agent, such as an antibody, which modulates the ability of the IL-35R to be activated by IL-35 but permits the IL-35R complex to be activated by other non-IL-35 ligands.
- agents can be IL-35R binding agents, a gp130 binding agent, or an IL12R ⁇ 2 binding agent.
- an “IL-35R binding agent” refers to any compound that directly interacts with or binds to the IL-35R complex.
- specific binding agent is intended an agent that binds substantially only to a defined target.
- an IL-35R specific binding agent interacts directly with IL-35R and binds substantially only to epitopes which are formed upon the interaction of IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130 to form the biologically active IL-35R.
- an IL-35R specific binding agent will not substantially interact with monomeric protein subunits comprising IL12R ⁇ 2 or gp130 and the agent will not substantially interact with homodimeric or non-IL-35R heterodimeric complexes which comprise IL12R ⁇ 2 or gp130 in a statistically significant amount.
- specifically or selectively binds to an IL-35R complex is intended that the binding agent has a binding affinity for a non-IL-35R epitope which is less than 10%, 9%, 8%, 7%, 6%, 5%, 4%, 3%, 2% or 1% of the binding affinity for the unique IL-35R epitope.
- An IL-35R specific binding agent may or may not modulate the activity of IL-35R.
- IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent an agent that possesses the properties of both an IL-35R specific binding agent and an IL-35R specific modulating agent.
- the IL-35R specific binding and/or modulating agent can be an IL-35R agonist or an IL-35R antagonist.
- IL-35 activation is intended any activity resulting from the binding of IL-35 to the IL-35R complex.
- an agent that “specifically inhibits” IL-35 activity of the IL-35R complex will substantially block the activity of IL-35R by IL-35, but will not significantly block the activity of IL-35R by a non-IL-35 ligand.
- the IL-35R binding and/or modulating agent is a small molecule.
- small molecules include, but are not limited to, peptides, peptidomimetics, amino acids, amino acid analogs, polynucleotides, polynucleotide analogs, nucleotides, nucleotide analogs, organic or inorganic compounds (i.e., including heterorganic and organometallic compounds).
- the invention includes antibodies that specifically bind to the IL-35R complex.
- Antibodies including monoclonal antibodies (mAbs), can be made by standard protocols. See, for example, Harlow and Lane, Using Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual , CSHL, New York, 1999. Briefly, a mammal such as a mouse, hamster or rabbit can be immunized with an immunogenic form of a peptide. Techniques for conferring immunogenicity on a protein or peptide include conjugation to carriers or other techniques, well known in the art. In preferred embodiments, the subject antibodies are immunospecific for the unique antigenic determinants of IL-35R.
- anti-IL-35R antibodies antibodies specific for IL-35R. All of these antibodies are encompassed by the discussion herein. The respective antibodies can be used alone or in combination in the methods of the invention.
- antibodies that specifically bind is intended that the antibodies will not substantially cross react with another polypeptide.
- not substantially cross react is intended that the antibody or fragment has a binding affinity for a non-homologous protein which is less than 10%, less than 5%, or less than 1%, of the binding affinity for the IL-35R complex.
- the anti-IL-35R antibody binds specifically to IL-35R and further modulates the activity of the IL-35R complex.
- the anti-IL-35R antibody is an IL-35R agonist or is an IL-35R antagonist.
- polyclonal sera may be prepared by conventional methods.
- a solution containing the IL-35R complex or an active variant or fragment thereof is first used to immunize a suitable animal, preferably a mouse, rat, rabbit, or goat.
- Rabbits or goats are preferred for the preparation of polyclonal sera due to the volume of serum obtainable, and the availability of labeled anti-rabbit and anti-goat antibodies.
- Polyclonal sera can be prepared in a transgenic animal, preferably a mouse bearing human immunoglobulin loci.
- Sf9 Spodoptera frugiperda
- cells expressing IL-35R are used as the immunogen Immunization can also be performed by mixing or emulsifying the antigen-containing solution in saline, preferably in an adjuvant such as Freund's complete adjuvant, and injecting the mixture or emulsion parenterally (generally subcutaneously or intramuscularly).
- a dose of 50-200 ⁇ g/injection is typically sufficient Immunization is generally boosted 2-6 weeks later with one or more injections of the protein in saline, preferably using Freund's incomplete adjuvant.
- Polyclonal antisera are obtained by bleeding the immunized animal into a glass or plastic container, incubating the blood at 25° C. for one hour, followed by incubating at 4° C. for 2-18 hours.
- the serum is recovered by centrifugation (e.g., 1,000 ⁇ g for 10 minutes). About 20-50 ml per bleed may be obtained from rabbits.
- sequences encoding IL-35R complex are recombined into a baculovirus using transfer vectors.
- the plasmids are co-transfected with wild-type baculovirus DNA into Sf9 cells.
- Recombinant baculovirus-infected Sf9 cells are identified and clonally purified.
- the antibody is monoclonal in nature.
- monoclonal antibody is an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, that is, the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible naturally occurring mutations that may be present in minor amounts.
- the term is not limited regarding the species or source of the antibody.
- the term encompasses whole immunoglobulins as well as fragments such as Fab, F(ab′)2, Fv, and others which retain the antigen binding function of the antibody.
- Monoclonal antibodies are highly specific, being directed against a single antigenic site on the target polypeptide.
- each monoclonal antibody is directed against a single determinant on the antigen.
- the modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method.
- the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the present invention may be made by the hybridoma method first described by Kohler and Milstein ( Nature 256:495-97, 1975), or may be made by recombinant DNA methods (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567).
- the “monoclonal antibodies” may also be isolated from phage antibody libraries using the techniques described in, for example, Clackson et al. ( Nature 352:624-28, 1991), Marks et al. ( J. Mol. Biol. 222:581-97, 1991) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,548.
- epitope is the part of an antigenic molecule to which an antibody is produced and to which the antibody will bind.
- Epitopes can comprise linear amino acid residues (i.e., residues within the epitope are arranged sequentially one after another in a linear fashion), nonlinear amino acid residues (referred to herein as “nonlinear epitopes”—these epitopes are not arranged sequentially), or both linear and nonlinear amino acid residues.
- mAbs can be prepared using the method of Kohler and Milstein, or a modification thereof.
- a mouse is immunized with a solution containing an antigen. Immunization can be performed by mixing or emulsifying the antigen-containing solution in saline, preferably in an adjuvant such as Freund's complete adjuvant, and injecting the mixture or emulsion parenterally. Any method of immunization known in the art may be used to obtain the monoclonal antibodies of the invention.
- the spleen and optionally, several large lymph nodes
- the spleen cells may be screened by applying a cell suspension to a plate or well coated with the antigen of interest.
- the B cells expressing membrane bound immunoglobulin specific for the antigen bind to the plate and are not rinsed away.
- Resulting B cells, or all dissociated spleen cells are then induced to fuse with myeloma cells to form hybridomas, and are cultured in a selective medium.
- the resulting cells are plated by serial dilution and are assayed for the production of antibodies that specifically bind the antigen of interest (and that do not bind to unrelated antigens).
- the selected mAb-secreting hybridomas are then cultured either in vitro (e.g., in tissue culture bottles or hollow fiber reactors), or in vivo (as ascites in mice).
- the DNA encoding the monoclonal antibodies is readily isolated and sequenced using conventional procedures (e.g., by using oligonucleotide probes that are capable of binding specifically to genes encoding the heavy and light chains of murine antibodies).
- the hybridoma cells described herein serve as a preferred source of such DNA.
- the DNA can be placed into expression vectors, which are then transfected into host cells such as E. coli cells, simian COS cells, Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) cells, or myeloma cells that do not otherwise produce immunoglobulin protein, to obtain the synthesis of monoclonal antibodies in the recombinant host cells.
- antibody can be produced in a cell line such as a CHO cell line, as disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,545,403; 5,545,405 and 5,998,144. Briefly the cell line is transfected with vectors capable of expressing a light chain and a heavy chain, respectively. By transfecting the two proteins on separate vectors, chimeric antibodies can be produced. Another advantage is the correct glycosylation of the antibody.
- anti-IL-35R antibody encompasses chimeric and humanized anti-IL-35R antibodies.
- chimeric antibodies is intended antibodies that are most preferably derived using recombinant deoxyribonucleic acid techniques and which comprise both human (including immunologically “related” species, e.g., chimpanzee) and non-human components.
- the constant region of the chimeric antibody is most preferably substantially identical to the constant region of a natural human antibody; the variable region of the chimeric antibody is most preferably derived from a non-human source and has the desired antigenic specificity to the IL-35R antigen.
- the non-human source can be any vertebrate source that can be used to generate antibodies to a human IL-35R antigen or material comprising a human IL-35R antigen.
- Such non-human sources include, but are not limited to, rodents (e.g., rabbit, rat, mouse, etc.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567) and non-human primates (e.g., Old World Monkeys, Apes, etc.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,750,105 and 5,756,096).
- rodents e.g., rabbit, rat, mouse, etc.
- non-human primates e.g., Old World Monkeys, Apes, etc.
- the phrase “immunologically active” when used in reference to chimeric/humanized anti-IL-35R antibodies means chimeric/human
- humanized antibodies are human immunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a hypervariable region (also known as complementarity determining region or CDR) of the recipient are replaced by residues from a hypervariable region of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and capacity.
- donor antibody such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and capacity.
- complementarity determining region refers to amino acid sequences which together define the binding affinity and specificity of the natural Fv region of a native immunoglobulin binding site. See, for example, Chothia et al. ( J.
- Humanization can be essentially performed following the methods described by Jones et al. ( Nature 321:522-25, 1986), Riechmann et al. ( Nature 332:323-27, 1988) and Verhoeyen et al. ( Science 239:1534-36, 1988), by substituting rodent or mutant rodent CDRs or CDR sequences for the corresponding sequences of a human antibody. See also U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,225,539; 5,585,089; 5,693,761; 5,693,762; and 5,859,205. In some instances, residues within the framework regions of one or more variable regions of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues (see, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos.
- humanized antibodies may comprise residues that are not found in the recipient antibody or in the donor antibody. These modifications are made to further refine antibody performance (e.g., to obtain desired affinity).
- the humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the hypervariable regions correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin and all or substantially all of the framework regions are those of a human immunoglobulin sequence.
- the humanized antibody optionally also will comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin. Accordingly, such “humanized” antibodies may include antibodies wherein substantially less than an intact human variable domain has been substituted by the corresponding sequence from a non-human species.
- anti-IL-35R antibodies are xenogeneic or modified anti-IL-35R antibodies produced in a non-human mammalian host, more particularly a transgenic mouse, characterized by inactivated endogenous immunoglobulin loci.
- transgenic animals competent endogenous genes for the expression of light and heavy subunits of host immunoglobulins are rendered non-functional and substituted with the analogous human immunoglobulin loci.
- transgenic animals produce human antibodies in the substantial absence of light or heavy host immunoglobulin subunits. See, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,877,397 and 5,939,598.
- fully human antibodies to IL-35 can be obtained by immunizing transgenic mice.
- One such mouse is disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,075,181; 6,091,001; and 6,114,598.
- Fragments of the anti-IL-35R antibodies are suitable for use in the methods of the invention so long as they retain the desired affinity of the full-length antibody.
- a fragment of an anti-IL-35R antibody will retain the ability to specifically bind to IL-35R.
- Such fragments are characterized by properties similar to the corresponding full-length anti-IL-35R antibody; that is, the fragments will specifically bind IL-35R.
- Such fragments are referred to herein as “antigen-binding” fragments.
- Suitable antigen-binding fragments of an antibody comprise a portion of a full-length antibody, generally the antigen-binding or variable region thereof.
- antibody fragments include, but are not limited to, Fab, F(ab′) 2 , and Fv fragments and single-chain antibody molecules.
- Fab is intended a monovalent antigen-binding fragment of an immunoglobulin that is composed of the light chain and part of the heavy chain.
- F(ab′) 2 is intended a bivalent antigen-binding fragment of an immunoglobulin that contains both light chains and part of both heavy chains.
- the Fv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the V H and V L domains that enables the sFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding.
- sFv see Pluckthun, A. (1994) in The Pharmacology of Monoclonal Antibodies , Vol. 113, ed. Rosenburg and Moore (Springer-Verlag, New York), pp. 269-315.
- Antibodies or antibody fragments can be isolated from antibody phage libraries generated using the techniques described in, for example, McCafferty et al. ( Nature 348:552-54, 1990) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,548. Clackson et al. ( Nature 352:624-28, 1991) and Marks et al. ( J. Mol. Biol. 222:581-97, 1991) describe the isolation of murine and human antibodies, respectively, using phage libraries.
- a representative assay to detect anti-IL-35R antibodies specific to the unique epitopes form upon complex formation of IL-35R is a “competitive binding assay.”
- Competitive binding assays are serological assays in which unknowns are detected and quantitated by their ability to inhibit the binding of a labeled known ligand to its specific antibody.
- Antibodies employed in such immunoassays may be labeled or unlabeled. Unlabeled antibodies may be employed in agglutination; labeled antibodies may be employed in a wide variety of assays, employing a wide variety of labels.
- Detection of the formation of an antibody-antigen complex between an anti-IL-35R antibody and an epitope of interest can be facilitated by attaching a detectable substance to the antibody.
- Suitable detection means include the use of labels such as radionucleotides, enzymes, coenzymes, fluorescers, chemiluminescers, chromogens, enzyme substrates or co-factors, enzyme inhibitors, prosthetic group complexes, free radicals, particles, dyes, and the like.
- labeled reagents may be used in a variety of well-known assays, such as radioimmunoassays, enzyme immunoassays, e.g., ELISA, fluorescent immunoassays, and the like. See, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,766,162; 3,791,932; 3,817,837; and 4,233,402.
- the antibody is bispecific, wherein a first antigen binding domain specifically interacts with an epitope of gp130 and said second antigen binding domain specifically interacts with an epitope of IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the mixture comprise a first antibody having a first chemical moiety and the first antibody binds substantially only to gp130 and a second antibody having a second chemical moiety and the second antibody bind substantially only to a second polypeptide comprising IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the first and the second chemical moiety allow for the interaction of said first and said second antibody at an IL-35R complex to be detected. Methods for such forms of detection and chemical moieties of interest are discussed elsewhere herein.
- compositions further include antibodies that specifically bind to the constituents of the IL-35R complex: gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2.
- techniques for conferring immunogenicity on a protein or peptide include conjugation to carriers or other techniques, well known in the art.
- anti-gp130 and anti-IL12R ⁇ 2 antibodies are immunospecific for the unique antigenic determinants of gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2, respectively.
- anti-gp130 antibody encompasses an antibody that binds substantially only to a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, where the antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex.
- anti-IL12R ⁇ 2_antibody encompasses an antibody that binds substantially only to an IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, where such an antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex.
- anti-gp130 and anti-IL12R ⁇ 2_antibodies can be “specific modulating agents” which modulate the ability of the IL-35R to be activated by IL-35 but permit the IL-35R complex to be activated by other non-IL-35 ligands.
- an anti-gp130 antibody can bind substantially only to a gp130 polypeptide, or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, and act as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R by substantially and specifically inhibiting IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex.
- IL-35R activation by non-IL-35 ligands can include, for example, the binding of Interleukin 27 (IL-27) or interleukin 12 (IL-12) to the IL-35R complex.
- IL-27 Interleukin 27
- IL-12 interleukin 12
- Methodologies provided herein for the production and use of anti-IL-35R antibodies can be adapted to make and use anti-gp130 and anti-IL12R ⁇ 2 antibodies,
- the various polynucleotides of the invention can be expressed in an expression cassette.
- An expression cassette comprises one or more regulatory sequences, selected on the basis of the cells to be used for expression, operably linked to the desired polynucleotide.
- “Operably linked” is intended to mean that the desired polynucleotide (i.e., gp130 and/or IL12R ⁇ 2 or active variants and fragments thereof) is linked to the regulatory sequence(s) in a manner that allows for expression of the nucleotide sequence (e.g., in an in vitro transcription/translation system or in a cell when the expression cassette or vector is introduced into a cell).
- regulatory sequences include promoters, enhancers, and other expression control elements (e.g., polyadenylation signals). See, for example, Goeddel (1990) in Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185 (Academic Press, San Diego, Calif.). Regulatory sequences include those that direct constitutive expression of a nucleotide sequence in many types of host cells, those that direct expression of the nucleotide sequence only in certain host cells (e.g., tissue-specific regulatory sequences), or those that direct expression of the polynucleotide in the presence of an appropriate inducer (inducible promoter).
- inducer inducible promoter
- expression cassette can depend on such factors as the choice of the host cell to be transformed, the level of expression of the polynucleotide that is desired, and the like.
- expression cassettes typically include one or more appropriately positioned sites for restriction enzymes, to facilitate introduction of the nucleic acid into a vector.
- heterologous in reference to a sequence is a sequence that originates from a foreign species, or, if from the same species, is substantially modified from its native form in composition and/or genomic locus by deliberate human intervention.
- a promoter operably linked to a heterologous polynucleotide is from a species different from the species from which the polynucleotide was derived, or, if from the same/analogous species, one or both are substantially modified from their original form and/or genomic locus, or the promoter is not the native promoter for the operably linked polynucleotide.
- a sequence that is heterologous to a cell is a sequence that originates from a foreign species, or, if from the same species, is substantially modified in the cell from its native form in composition and/or genomic locus by deliberate human intervention.
- the promoter utilized to direct intracellular expression of a silencing element is a promoter for RNA polymerase III (Pol III).
- Pol III RNA polymerase III
- RNA polymerase I e.g., a tRNA promoter
- a promoter for RNA polymerase I can be used. See McCown et al. (2003) Virology 313(2):514-24; Kawasaki (2003) Nucleic Acids Res. 31 (2):700-7.
- the regulatory sequences can also be provided by viral regulatory elements.
- promoters are derived from polyoma, Adenovirus 2, cytomegalovirus, and Simian Virus 40.
- suitable expression systems for both prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells see Chapters 16 and 17 of Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.). See, Goeddel (1990) in Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185 (Academic Press, San Diego, Calif.).
- rat insulin promoter glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase
- glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase.
- Promoters which may be used include, but are not limited to, the long terminal repeat as described in Squinto et al.
- elastase I gene control region which is active in pancreatic acinar cells (Swift et al. (1984) Cell 38:639 646; Ornitz et al. (1986) Cold Spring Harbor Symp. Quant. Biol. 50:399 409; MacDonald, 1987, Hepatology Z:425 515); insulin gene control region which is active in pancreatic beta cells (Hanahan (1985) Nature 315:115 122), immunoglobulin gene control region which is active in lymphoid cells (Grosschedl et al.
- Inducible promoters are also known.
- inducible promoters and their inducer inlcude MT II/Phorbol Ester (TPA) (Palmiter et al. (1982) Nature 300:611) and heavy metals (Haslinger and Karin (1985) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 82:8572; Searle et al. (1985) Mol. Cell. Biol. 5:1480; Stuart et al. (1985) Nature 317:828; Imagawa et al. (1987) Cell 51:251; Karin et al. (1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:606; Angel et al.
- HSP70/E1a SV40 Large T Antigen
- Proliferin/Phorbol Ester-TPA Mordacq and Linzer (1989) Genes and Dev. 3:760
- Tumor Necrosis Factor/PMA Hensel et al. (1989) Lymphokine Res. 8:347)
- Thyroid Stimulating Hormone ⁇ Gene/Thyroid Hormone Choatterjee et al. (1989) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 86:9114
- Insulin E Box/Glucose Insulin E Box/Glucose.
- Such expression cassettes can be contained in a vector which allow for the introduction of the expression cassette into a cell.
- the vector allows for autonomous replication of the expression cassette in a cell or may be integrated into the genome of a cell.
- Such vectors are replicated along with the host genome (e.g., nonepisomal mammalian vectors).
- expression vectors of utility in recombinant DNA techniques are often in the form of plasmids (vectors).
- the invention is intended to include such other forms of expression vectors, such as viral vectors (e.g., replication defective retroviruses, adenoviruses, and adeno-associated viruses). See, for example, U.S. Publication 2005214851, herein incorporated by reference.
- any expression cassette can further comprise a selection marker.
- selection marker comprises any polynucleotide, which when expressed in a cell allows for the selection of the transformed cell with the vector.
- a selection marker can confer resistance to a drug, a nutritional requirement, or a cytotoxic drug.
- a selection marker can also induce a selectable phenotype such as fluorescence or a color deposit.
- a “positive selection marker” allows a cell expressing the marker to survive against a selective agent and thus confers a positive selection characteristic onto the cell expressing that marker.
- Positive selection marker/agents include, for example, Neo/G418, Neo/Kanamycin, Hyg/Hygromycin, hisD/Histidinol, Gpt/Xanthine, Ble/Bleomycin, HPRT/Hypoxanthine.
- Other positive selection markers include DNA sequences encoding membrane bound polypeptides.
- Such polypeptides are well known to those skilled in the art and can comprise, for example, a secretory sequence, an extracellular domain, a transmembrane domain and an intracellular domain. When expressed as a positive selection marker, such polypeptides associate with the cell membrane. Fluorescently labeled antibodies specific for the extracellular domain may then be used in a fluorescence activated cell sorter (FACS) to select for cells expressing the membrane bound polypeptide. FACS selection may occur before or after negative selection.
- FACS fluorescence activated cell sorter
- Negative selection marker allows the cell expressing the marker to not survive against a selective agent and thus confers a negative selection characteristic onto the cell expressing the marker.
- Negative selection marker/agents include, for example, HSV-tk/Acyclovir or Gancyclovir or FIAU, Hprt/6-thioguanine, Gpt/6-thioxanthine, cytosine deaminase/5-fluoro-cytosine, diphtheria toxin or the ricin toxin. See, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,464,764, herein incorporated by reference.
- the various DNA fragments may be manipulated, so as to provide for the DNA sequences in the proper orientation and, as appropriate, in the proper reading frame.
- adapters or linkers may be employed to join the DNA fragments or other manipulations may be involved to provide for convenient restriction sites, removal of superfluous DNA, removal of restriction sites, or the like.
- in vitro mutagenesis, primer repair, restriction, annealing, resubstitutions, e.g., transitions and transversions may be involved.
- an “isolated” or “purified” polynucleotide or protein, or biologically active portion thereof, is substantially or essentially free from components that normally accompany or interact with the polynucleotide or protein as found in its naturally occurring environment.
- an isolated or purified protein is substantially free of other cellular material, or culture medium when produced by recombinant techniques, or substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized.
- an “isolated” polynucleotide is free of sequences (optimally protein encoding sequences) that naturally flank the polynucleotide (i.e., sequences located at the 5′ and 3′ ends of the polynucleotide) in the genomic DNA of the organism from which the polynucleotide is derived.
- the isolated polynucleotide can contain less than about 5 kb, 4 kb, 3 kb, 2 kb, 1 kb, 0.5 kb, or 0.1 kb of nucleotide sequence that naturally flank the polynucleotide in genomic DNA of the cell from which the polynucleotide is derived.
- a protein that is substantially free of cellular material includes preparations of protein having less than about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, or 1% (by dry weight) of contaminating protein.
- optimally culture medium represents less than about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, or 1% (by dry weight) of chemical precursors or non-protein-of-interest chemicals.
- polynucleotide is not intended to limit the present invention to polynucleotides comprising DNA.
- polynucleotides can comprise ribonucleotides and combinations of ribonucleotides and deoxyribonucleotides.
- deoxyribonucleotides and ribonucleotides include both naturally occurring molecules and synthetic analogues.
- the polynucleotides of the invention also encompass all forms of sequences including, but not limited to, single-stranded forms, double-stranded forms, hairpins, stem-and-loop structures, and the like.
- the cell is from a mammal, a primate, a human, a domestic animal or an agricultural animal.
- the cell is a non-human cell.
- Non-limiting animals that the cell can be derived from include cattle, sheep, goats, pigs, horses, rabbits, dogs, monkeys, cats, large felines (lions, tigers, etc.), wolves, mice, rats, rabbits, deer, mules, bears, cows, pigs, horses, oxen, zebras, elephants, and so on.
- the cell can further be from a plant, a worm (e.g., C.
- the cells can be derived from any tissue (diseased or healthy) from any of these organisms.
- Expression of IL-35R can be engineered to occur in any cell type that one would want to control growth or proliferation of, especially tumor cells or tissues/cells that are common targets of autoimmune diseases.
- host cells include cultured cells (in vitro), explants and primary cultures (in vitro and ex vivo).
- the present invention further provides transgenic animals expressing a first heterologous polynucleotide encoding gp130 or an active variant or fragment thereof and a second heterologous polynucleotide encoding an IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- Such animals are useful as animal models having modulated IL-35R activity, including for example, animal models having modulated effector T cell function.
- methods of generating transgenic animals and transformed cell lines are well known in the art (for example, see Grosveld et al., Transgenic Animals, Academic Press Ltd., San Diego, Calif. (1992)).
- a skilled artisan can readily generate transgenic animals and transformed cell lines which contain and express both heterologous sequences.
- Such animals serve as models for the development of alternative therapies for therapies that modulate effector T cell function.
- Such methods of the invention involve introducing a polypeptide or polynucleotide into a cell.
- “Introducing” is intended to mean presenting to the cell the polynucleotide or polypeptide in such a manner that the sequence gains access to the interior of a cell of the plant.
- the methods of the invention do not depend on a particular method for introducing a sequence into a cell, only that the polynucleotide or polypeptides gains access to the interior of a cell.
- Methods for introducing polynucleotide or polypeptides into various cell types are known in the art including, but not limited to, stable transformation methods, transient transformation methods, and virus-mediated methods.
- “Stable transformation” is intended to mean that the nucleotide construct introduced into a cell integrates into the DNA of the cell and is capable of being inherited by the progeny thereof “Transient transformation” is intended to mean that a polynucleotide is introduced into the cell and does not integrate into the genome of the cell or a polypeptide is introduced into a cell. Transformation protocols as well as protocols for introducing polypeptides or polynucleotide sequences into cell may vary depending on the type of cell targeted for transformation.
- Exemplary art-recognized techniques for introducing foreign polynucleotides into a host cell include, but are not limited to, calcium phosphate or calcium chloride co-precipitation, DEAE-dextran-mediated transfection, lipofection, particle gun, or electroporation and viral vectors.
- Suitable methods for transforming or transfecting host cells can be found in U.S. Pat. No. 5,049,386, U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,787; and U.S. Pat. No. 4,897,355, Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.) and other standard molecular biology laboratory manuals.
- transfection agents can be used in these techniques. Such agent are known, see for example, WO 2005012487.
- the silencing element can be stably incorporated into the genome of the cell, replicated on an autonomous vector or plasmid, or present transiently in the cell.
- Viral vector delivery systems include DNA and RNA viruses, which have either episomal or integrated genomes after delivery to the cell.
- Conventional viral based systems for the delivery of polynucleotides could include retroviral, lentivirus, adenoviral, adeno-associated and herpes simplex virus vectors for gene transfer. Integration in the host genome is possible with the retrovirus, lentivirus, and adeno-associated virus gene transfer methods, often resulting in long term expression of the inserted transgene.
- the polynucleotide(s) encoding the IL-35R complex and active variants and fragments thereof, the IL-35R complex and active variants and fragments thereof, the soluble form of the IL-35R complex, the IL-35R specific binding and/or modulating agents, and the IL-35R agonist and antagonists disclosed herein can be used in one or more of the following methods: (a) screening assays; (b) detection assays; (c) predictive medicine (e.g., diagnostic assays, prognostic assays, monitoring clinical trials, and pharmacogenomics); and (d) methods of treatment (e.g., therapeutic and prophylactic).
- the invention provides a method (also referred to herein as a “screening assay”) for identifying binding and/or modulating agents of IL-35R.
- a method also referred to herein as a “screening assay” for identifying binding and/or modulating agents of IL-35R.
- identification of various IL-35R binding agents are of interest including agonist IL-35R binding agents, antagonist IL-35R binding agents, and IL-35R specific binding agents.
- identification of various IL-35R modulating agents are of interest including, for example, IL-35R agonist and antagonists.
- test compounds employed in the various screening assays can include any candidate compound including, for example, peptides, peptidomimetics, small molecules, antibodies, or other drugs.
- candidate compound including, for example, peptides, peptidomimetics, small molecules, antibodies, or other drugs.
- test compounds can be obtained using any of the numerous approaches in combinatorial library methods known in the art, including biological libraries, spatially addressable parallel solid phase or solution phase libraries, synthetic library methods requiring deconvolution, the “one-bead one-compound” library method, and synthetic library methods using affinity chromatography selection.
- the biological library approach is limited to peptide libraries, while the other four approaches are applicable to peptide, nonpeptide oligomer, or small molecule libraries of compounds (Lam (1997) Anticancer Drug Des. 12:145).
- Determining the ability of the test compound to bind to the IL-35R complex can be accomplished, for example, by coupling the test compound with a radioisotope or enzymatic label such that binding of the test compound to the IL-35R complex or a biologically active portion thereof can be determined by detecting the labeled compound in a complex.
- test compounds can be labeled with 125 I, 35 S, 14 C, or 3 H, either directly or indirectly, and the radioisotope detected by direct counting of radioemmission or by scintillation counting.
- test compounds can be enzymatically labeled with, for example, horseradish peroxidase, alkaline phosphatase, or luciferase, and the enzymatic label detected by determination of conversion of an appropriate substrate to product.
- an assay is a cell-free assay comprising contacting an IL-35R complex or biologically active fragment or variant thereof with a test compound and determining the ability of the test compound to bind to the IL-35R complex or the biologically active variant or fragment thereof. Binding of the test compound to the IL-35R complex can be determined either directly or indirectly. An indirect assay could include assaying for a modulation in IL-35R activity. In a further embodiment, the test or candidate compound specifically binds to or selectively binds to the IL-35R complex.
- the assay includes contacting the IL-35R complex or biologically active variant or fragment thereof with a known compound that binds to the IL-35R complex (such as its ligand, IL-35) to form an assay mixture, contacting the assay mixture with a test compound, and determining the ability of the test compound to preferentially bind to IL-35R complex or biologically active fragment or variant thereof as compared to the known compound.
- a known compound that binds to the IL-35R complex such as its ligand, IL-35
- an assay comprises contacting the IL-35R complex or biologically active portion thereof with a test compound and determining the ability of the test compound to modulate (e.g., stimulate or inhibit, act as an agonist or antagonist) the activity of the IL-35R complex or biologically active portion thereof. Determining the ability of the test compound to modulate the activity of an IL-35R complex can be accomplished, for example, by determining the ability of the IL-35R complex to bind to its ligand, IL-35, as described above, for determining direct binding.
- determining the ability of the test compound to modulate the activity of an IL-35R complex can be accomplished by determining the ability of the IL-35R complex to further modulate intercellular downstream pathways modulated by IL-35R. Such activities are discussed elsewhere herein.
- a fusion protein can be provided that adds a domain that allows the IL-35R complex or active fragment or variant thereof or the test agent to be bound to a matrix.
- glutathione-S-transferase/IL-35R complex fusion proteins or glutathione-S-transferase/IL-35R complex fusion proteins can be adsorbed onto glutathione sepharose beads (Sigma Chemical, St.
- IL-35R complex or active fragment thereof or the test compound can be immobilized utilizing conjugation of biotin and streptavidin.
- Biotinylated IL-35R complexes or active fragments thereof or test agents can be prepared from biotin-NHS (N-hydroxy-succinimide) using techniques well known in the art (e.g., biotinylation kit, Pierce Chemicals, Rockford, Ill.), and immobilized in the wells of streptavidin-coated 96-well plates (Pierce Chemicals).
- the IL-35R complex can be used as “bait proteins” in a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al. (1993) Cell 72:223-232; Madura et al. (1993) J. Biol. Chem. 268:12046-12054; Bartel et al. (1993) Bio/Techniques 14:920-924; Iwabuchi et al. (1993) Oncogene 8:1693-1696; and PCT Publication No. WO 94/10300), to identify other proteins, which bind to or interact with the IL-35R complex or active fragments and variants thereof and, in some embodiments, modulate IL-35R complex activity.
- This invention further pertains to novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays and uses thereof for treatments as described herein.
- a biological sample can comprise any sample in which one desires to determine the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 or one desires to detect or quantitate the level of the IL-35R complex.
- biological sample is intended to include tissues, cells, and biological fluids isolated from a subject, as well as tissues, cells, and fluids present within a subject. Detection of the expression of IL-35R in any cell type that expresses IL-35R can be performed, including expression levels in either diseased verses healthy tissue.
- the detection method of the invention can be used to detect gp130 mRNA or genomic DNA, IL12R ⁇ 2 mRNA or genomic DNA, or the IL-35R complex in a biological sample in vitro, as well as, in vivo.
- in vitro techniques for detection of include Northern hybridizations and in situ hybridizations.
- in vitro techniques for detection of the IL-35R complex include enzyme linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), Western blots, immunoprecipitations, and immunofluorescence.
- In vitro techniques for detection of genomic DNA include Southern hybridizations.
- in vivo techniques for detection of the IL-35R complex include introducing into a subject a labeled anti-IL-35R specific antibody.
- the antibody can be labeled with a radioactive marker whose presence and location in a subject can be detected by standard imaging techniques.
- a method for detecting the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or active variants and fragments thereof and IL12R ⁇ 2 or active variants and fragments thereof in a sample comprises contacting the sample with a) a first and a second primer capable of specifically amplifying a first amplicon comprising a polynucleotide encoding a gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a third and a fourth primer capable of specifically amplifying a second amplicon comprising a polynucleotide encoding an IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex.
- the first and the second amplicon is amplified and then detected.
- a method for detecting the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or active variants and fragments thereof and IL12R ⁇ 2 or active variants and fragments thereof in a sample comprises contacting the sample with a) a first polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting a polynucleotide encoding a gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a second polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting a polynucleotide encoding an IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex; and detecting the polynucleotide encoding the gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof and detecting the polynucleotide encoding the IL12R ⁇ 2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- the sample is contacted with a polynucleotide probe that hybridizes under stringent hybridization conditions to the target sequences to be detected.
- the sample and probes are then subjected the sample and probe to stringent hybridization conditions and the hybridization of the probe to the target sequences is detected.
- Primers and probes are based on the sequence of the polynucleotides encoded by gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 or active variants and fragments thereof. Any conventional nucleic acid hybridization or amplification method can be used to identify the presence of the polynucleotides encoded by gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 in a sample.
- polynucleotide can be used either as a primer to specifically amplify an amplicon of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 or the polynucleotide can be used as a probe that hybridizes under stringent conditions to a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the level or degree of hybridization which allows for the specific detection or the specific amplification of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 is sufficient to distinguish the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 from a polynucleotide that does not encode the recited polypeptide.
- “stringent conditions” are conditions that permit the primer pair to hybridize to the target polynucleotide to which a primer having the corresponding wild-type sequence (or its complement) would bind and preferably to produce an identifiable amplification product (the amplicon) in a DNA thermal amplification reaction.
- oligonucleotide primers can be designed for use in PCR reactions to amplify a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the amplified polynucleotide can be of any length that allows for the detection of the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the amplicon can be about 10, 50, 100, 200, 300, 500, 700, 100, 2000, 3000, 4000, 5000 nucleotides in length or longer.
- the first primer pair comprises primers comprising a fragment of a polynucleotide encoding gp130, wherein the first primer pair shares sufficient sequence identity or complementarity to the polynucleotide to amplify the polynucleotide encoding gp130; and, the second primer pair comprises primers comprising a fragment of a polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2, wherein the first primer pair shares sufficient sequence identity or complementarity to the polynucleotide to amplify the polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the primer can comprise at least 8, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40 or greater consecutive nucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 1, 2, 4 or 5.
- a nucleic acid molecule In order for a nucleic acid molecule to serve as a primer or probe it need only be sufficiently complementary in sequence to be able to form a stable double-stranded structure under the particular solvent and salt concentrations employed.
- a polynucleotide that selectively hybridizes to a target polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 is employed.
- stringent conditions or “stringent hybridization conditions” when referring to a polynucleotide probe is intended conditions under which a probe will hybridize to its target sequence to a detectably greater degree than to other sequences (e.g., at least 2-fold over background). Stringent conditions are sequence-dependent and will be different in different circumstances. By controlling the stringency of the hybridization and/or washing conditions, target sequences that are 100% complementary to the probe can be identified (homologous probing).
- stringency conditions can be adjusted to allow some mismatching in sequences so that lower degrees of identity are detected (heterologous probing).
- a probe is less than about 1000 nucleotides in length or less than 500 nucleotides in length.
- a substantially identical or complementary sequence is a polynucleotide that will specifically hybridize to the complement of the nucleic acid molecule to which it is being compared under high stringency conditions.
- Appropriate stringency conditions which promote DNA hybridization for example, 6Xsodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45° C., followed by a wash of 2 ⁇ SSC at 50° C., are known to those skilled in the art or can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology , John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. (1989), 6.3.1-6.3.6.
- stringent conditions for hybridization and detection will be those in which the salt concentration is less than about 1.5 M Na ion, typically about 0.01 to 1.0 M Na ion concentration (or other salts) at pH 7.0 to 8.3 and the temperature is at least about 30° C. for short probes (e.g., 10 to 50 nucleotides) and at least about 60° C. for long probes (e.g., greater than 50 nucleotides).
- Stringent conditions may also be achieved with the addition of destabilizing agents such as formamide.
- Exemplary moderate stringency conditions include hybridization in 40 to 45% formamide, 1.0 M NaCl, 1% SDS at 37° C., and a wash in 0.5 ⁇ to 1 ⁇ SSC at 55 to 60° C.
- Exemplary high stringency conditions include hybridization in 50% formamide, 1 M NaCl, 1% SDS at 37° C., and a wash in 0.1 ⁇ SSC at 60 to 65° C.
- wash buffers may comprise about 0.1% to about 1% SDS.
- Duration of hybridization is generally less than about 24 hours, usually about 4 to about 12 hours. The duration of the wash time will be at least a length of time sufficient to reach equilibrium.
- T m 81.5° C.+16.6 (log M)+0.41 (% GC)-0.61 (% form)-500/L; where M is the molarity of monovalent cations, % GC is the percentage of guanosine and cytosine nucleotides in the DNA, % form is the percentage of formamide in the hybridization solution, and L is the length of the hybrid in base pairs.
- the T m is the temperature (under defined ionic strength and pH) at which 50% of a complementary target sequence hybridizes to a perfectly matched probe. T m is reduced by about 1° C. for each 1% of mismatching; thus, T m , hybridization, and/or wash conditions can be adjusted to hybridize to sequences of the desired identity. For example, if sequences with >90% identity are sought, the T m can be decreased 10° C.
- stringent conditions are selected to be about 5° C. lower than the thermal melting point (T m ) for the specific sequence and its complement at a defined ionic strength and pH. However, severely stringent conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 1, 2, 3, or 4° C.
- T m thermal melting point
- moderately stringent conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10° C. lower than the thermal melting point (T m ); low stringency conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, or 20° C. lower than the thermal melting point (T m ).
- T m thermal melting point
- a polynucleotide is said to be the “complement” of another polynucleotide if they exhibit complementarity.
- molecules are said to exhibit “complete complementarity” when every nucleotide of one of the polynucleotide molecules is complementary to a nucleotide of the other.
- Two molecules are said to be “minimally complementary” if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under at least conventional “low-stringency” conditions.
- the molecules are said to be “complementary” if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under conventional “high-stringency” conditions.
- One aspect of the present invention relates to assays for detecting IL-35R complexes in the context of a biological sample.
- An exemplary method for detecting the presence or absence or the quantity of the IL-35R complex in a biological sample involves obtaining a biological sample and contacting the biological sample with a compound or an agent capable of specifically binding and detecting an IL-35R complex, such that the presence of the IL-35R complex is detected in the biological sample.
- Results obtained with a biological sample from a test subject may be compared to results obtained with a biological sample from a control subject.
- Detection of IL-35R with an IL-35R specific binding agent allows for the detection, purification, and/or isolation of cell populations expressing IL-35R. Such methods find use in determining cell populations that are sensitive or resistant to the effects of IL-35. Information gained by such techniques can then be used when designing IL-35 treatments or therapies.
- an agent for detecting the IL-35R complex is an antibody capable of specifically binding to the IL-35R complex, preferably an antibody with a detectable label.
- Antibodies can be polyclonal, or more preferably, monoclonal. An intact antibody, or a fragment thereof (e.g., Fab or F(abN) 2 ) can be used.
- the term “labeled”, with regard to the probe or antibody, is intended to encompass direct labeling of the probe or antibody by coupling (i.e., physically linking) a detectable substance to the probe or antibody, as well as indirect labeling of the probe or antibody by reactivity with another reagent that is directly labeled. Examples of indirect labeling include detection of a primary antibody using a fluorescently labeled secondary antibody.
- kit refers to a set of reagents for the identification and/or the detection of the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12R ⁇ 2 or detection and/or quantitation of the IL-35R complex in biological samples.
- kit and system are intended to refer to at least one or more detection reagents which, in specific embodiments, are in combination with one or more other types of elements or components (e.g., other types of biochemical reagents, containers, packages, such as packaging intended for commercial sale, substrates to which detection reagents are attached, electronic hardware components, instructions of use, and the like).
- a kit for determining the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and IL12R ⁇ 2 in a sample comprises a) a first polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding a first polypeptide encoding gp130 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a second polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex.
- the kit comprises a) a first and a second primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant or fragment thereof to specifically amplify the polynucleotide encoding gp130; and, b) a third and a forth primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to a polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2 or an active variant or fragment thereof to specifically amplify the polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2.
- the kit comprises a) a first probe that can specifically detect the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the first probe comprises at least one polynucleotide of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant thereof; and, b) a second probe that can specifically detect a second polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2 or an active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the second probe comprises at least one polynucleotide of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to a polynucleotide encoding IL12R ⁇ 2 or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- the first polynucleotide hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence encoding the gp130 polypeptide or active variant thereof; and, the second polynucleotide hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence encoding IL12R ⁇ 2 or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- kits for determining the presence of Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) in a sample can comprises any IL-35R specific binding and/or IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent disclosed herein, including, but not limited to one or more of the IL-35R specific antibodies disclosed herein or any mixture thereof
- Methods for modulating i.e., inducing, inhibiting, potentiating, elevating, increasing, decreasing
- Such methods can comprise contacting a cell expressing the IL-35R complex with an IL-35R antagonists or agonists.
- cognate T cells or “effector T cells” refer to a subpopulation of mature T cells that facilitate an immune response through cell activation and/or the secretion of cytokines.
- effector T cells include cytotoxic T cells (Tc), including for example, CD8+ cells, and helper T cells (Th1 cells, Th2 cells, CD4+, Th17, Th9, and gamma delta T-cells).
- effector T cell function includes an activity exerted by an effector T cell, as determined in vitro or in vivo, according to standard techniques.
- the effector T cell function includes the elimination of an antigen by, for example, the production of cytokines preferentially associated with effector T cells, which modulate the activation of other cells, or by cytotoxic activity.
- an effector T cell function is a cytotoxic (or cytolytic) T cell (Tc or CTL) function, such as, for example, cytolysis of cells infected with microbes.
- an effector T cell function is a Th1 cell function, e.g., mediation of delayed type hypersensitivity responses and macrophage activation.
- an effector T cell function is a Th2 cell function, e.g., help to B cells (Mosmann et al. (1989) Annu.
- an effector T cell function includes an inflammatory response, the suppression of immunological tolerance, or “tipping the balance” toward a proliferative/stimulatory environment.
- effector T cell function is enhanced or inhibited by a statistically significant amount, for example, by at least 5%, at least 10%, at least 15%, at least 20%, at least 30%, at least 50%, at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, or at least 90% as compared to an appropriate control cells.
- an IL-35R agonist will act to suppress or inhibit effector T-cell activity.
- the agonist can be, for example, an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent or an IL-35R specific modulating agent.
- inhibiting or suppressing an effector T cell function in a subject is intended reducing and/or blocking of one or more of the functions mediated by effector T cells.
- a method of suppressing an effector T cell function is provided and comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agonist.
- IL-35R Interleukin 35 Receptor
- an IL-35R agonist promotes immune tolerance, which can find use, for example, in treating a subject having an autoimmune or an inflammatory disorder, including but not limited to, graft rejections and allergies.
- a method of treating a subject having an autoimmune or inflammatory disorder comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an agonist Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent.
- IL-35R Interleukin 35 Receptor
- IL-35R Various agonist Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agents and method for preparing such agents are discuses elsewhere herein.
- the agonist agent is an antibody or a small molecule.
- autoimmune diseases include, for example, type 1 diabetes, rheumatoid arthritis and multiple sclerosis.
- Inflammatory disorders that may be treated include, for example, asthma and inflammatory bowel disease.
- limiting IL-35 by IL-35 antagonist could help enhance anti-tumor immunity elicited by effector T cells.
- the IL-35R agonist can be used in combination with a therapeutic agent to reduce the immune response to the agent (i.e., protein).
- the agent i.e., protein
- the IL-35R agonist can be used in combination with a therapeutic protein which must be chronically administered to a subject.
- the method comprises includes administering to the subject at least one additional therapeutic agent in combination with an IL-35R agonist.
- Such therapeutic agents include but are not limited to, a cytokine, a glucocorticoid, an anthracycline (e.g., doxorubicin or epirubicin), a fluoroquinolone (e.g., ciprofloxacin), an antifolate (e.g., methotrexate), an antimetabolite (e.g., fluorouracil), a topoisomerase inhibitor (e.g., camptothecin, irinotecan or etoposide), an alkylating agent (e.g., cyclophosphamide, ifosfamide, mitolactol, or melphalan), an antiandrogen (e.g., flutamide), an antiestrogen (e.g., tamoxifen), a platinum compound (e.g., cisplatin), a vinca alkaloid (e.g., vinorelbine, vinblastine or
- an IL-35R antagonist will act to enhance or promote effector T-cell activity.
- the antagonist can be, for example, an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent or an IL-35R specific modulating agent.
- enhancing an effector T cell function in a subject is intended reducing and/or blocking one or more of the functions mediated by effector T cells.
- an IL-35R antagonist will act to increase or potentiate at least one effector T cell function and thereby increase the immune response.
- a method of increasing an effector T cell function is provided and comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent.
- IL-35R antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor
- IL-35R antagonists find use in treating any conditions in which the IL-35 mediated activity of the T regulatory cells is shown to be blocking or limiting disease resolution.
- the IL-35R antagonists find use when activation of effector responses is desired such as in cases of acute infection, vaccine response, anti-tumor immunity or treating cancer.
- a method of treating a subject having a cancer or acute infection comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent.
- IL-35R antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor
- IL-35R antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor
- the antagonist agent is an antibody or a small molecule.
- the various IL-35R antagonists can be used in combination with an antigen to enhance the immune response to the antigen.
- T effector cell responses employing an IL-35R antagonist can be used to enhance a vaccine preparation.
- the various IL-35R antagonist are useful for increasing the efficacy of anti-cancer vaccines or for vaccines that are poorly immunogenic.
- a vaccine for enhancing the efficacy or immunogenicity of a vaccine in a subject, or overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine in a subject, including (i) administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an antagonist IL-35R agent and (ii) administering to the subject a vaccine.
- the antagonist is an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent.
- the vaccine is a cancer vaccine.
- immune responses are suppressed in cancer and chronic infections and thus combining IL-35R agonists with therapeutic cancer vaccines or vaccines against chronic infections such as HCV, HIV and TB could improve efficacy.
- vacuna is intended a composition useful for stimulating a specific immune response (or immunogenic response) in a subject.
- the immunogenic response is protective or provides protective immunity.
- the vaccine in the case of a disease-causing organism the vaccine enables the subject to better resist infection with or disease progression from the organism against which the vaccine is directed.
- the vaccine strengthens the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed. These types of vaccines may also prevent the further growth of existing cancers, prevent the recurrence of treated cancers, and/or eliminate cancer cells not killed by prior treatments.
- Representative vaccines include, but are not limited to, vaccines against diphtheria, tetanus, pertussis, polio, measles, mumps, rubella, hepatitis B, Haemophilus influenzae type b, varicella, meningitis, human immunodeficiency virus, tuberculosis, Epstein Barr virus, malaria, hepatitis E, dengue, rotavirus, herpes, human papillomavirus, and cancers.
- Vaccines of interest include the two vaccines that have been licensed by the U.S.
- hepatitis B vaccine which prevents infection with the hepatitis B virus, an infectious agent associated with liver cancer ( MMWR Morb. Mortal. Wkly. Rep. 46:107-09, 1997); and GardasilTM which prevents infection with the two types of human papillomavirus that together cause 70 percent of cervical cancer cases worldwide (Speck and Tyring, Skin Therapy Lett. 11:1-3, 2006).
- Other treatment vaccines of interest include therapeutic vaccines for the treatment of cervical cancer, follicular B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, kidney cancer, cutaneous melanoma, ocular melanoma, prostate cancer, and multiple myeloma.
- enhancement refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% increase in a particular parameter. In another embodiment, enhancement refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% decrease in a particular parameter. In one example, enhancement of the efficacy/immunogenicity of a vaccine refers to an increase in the ability of the vaccine to inhibit or treat disease progression, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% increase in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- enhancement of the efficacy/immunogenicity of a vaccine refers to an increase in the ability of the vaccine to recruit the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% increase in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- overcoming a suppressed immune response with regard to a vaccine is intended improving an outcome, for example, as measured by a change in a specific value, such as a return to a formerly positive value in a particular parameter of an activity of a vaccine associated with protective immunity.
- overcoming refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% increase in a particular parameter.
- overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine refers to a renewed ability of the vaccine to inhibit or treat disease progression, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% renewal in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine refers to a renewed ability of the vaccine to recruit the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% renewal in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- a therapeutically effective amount of an IL-35R antagonist or agonist can be administered to a subject.
- therapeutically effective amount is intended an amount that is useful in the treatment, prevention or diagnosis of a disease or condition.
- a therapeutically effective amount of an IL-R35 agonist or antagonist is an amount which, when administered to a subject, is sufficient to achieve a desired effect, such as modulating (inhibiting or promoting) effector T cell function in a subject being treated with that composition without causing a substantial cytotoxic effect in the subject.
- the effective amount of an IL-35R— agonist or antagonist useful for modulating effector T-cell function will depend on the subject being treated, the severity of the affliction, and the manner of administration of the IL-35R-agonist or antagonist.
- subject is intended mammals, e.g., primates, humans, agricultural and domesticated animals such as, but not limited to, dogs, cats, cattle, horses, pigs, sheep, and the like.
- subject undergoing treatment with the pharmaceutical formulations of the invention is a human.
- administration When administration is for the purpose of treatment, administration may be for either a prophylactic or therapeutic purpose.
- the substance When provided prophylactically, the substance is provided in advance of any symptom.
- the prophylactic administration of the substance serves to prevent or attenuate any subsequent symptom.
- the substance When provided therapeutically, the substance is provided at (or shortly after) the onset of a symptom.
- the therapeutic administration of the substance serves to attenuate any actual symptom.
- treatment of a subject with a therapeutically effective amount of an IL-35R agonist or antagonist can include a single treatment or, preferably, can include a series of treatments. It will also be appreciated that the effective dosage of an IL-35R agonist or antagonist used for treatment may increase or decrease over the course of a particular treatment. Changes in dosage may result and become apparent from the results of diagnostic assays as described herein.
- doses of such active compounds depends upon a number of factors within the knowledge of the ordinarily skilled physician, veterinarian, or researcher.
- the dose(s) of the active compounds will vary, for example, depending upon the identity, size, and condition of the subject or sample being treated, further depending upon the route by which the composition is to be administered, if applicable, and the effect which the practitioner desires the active compound to have upon the IL-35R complex.
- Exemplary doses include milligram or microgram amounts of the small molecule per kilogram of subject or sample weight (e.g., about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 500 milligrams per kilogram, about 100 micrograms per kilogram to about 5 milligrams per kilogram, or about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 50 micrograms per kilogram.
- appropriate doses of an active agent depend upon the potency of the active agent with respect to the expression or activity to be modulated. Such appropriate doses may be determined using the assays described herein.
- a physician, veterinarian, or researcher may, for example, prescribe a relatively low dose at first, subsequently increasing the dose until an appropriate response is obtained.
- the specific dose level for any particular animal subject will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, gender, and diet of the subject, the time of administration, the route of administration, the rate of excretion, any drug combination, and the degree of expression or activity to be modulated.
- Therapeutically effective amounts of an IL-35R-specific binding and/or modulating agent can be determined by animal studies. When animal assays are used, a dosage is administered to provide a target tissue concentration similar to that which has been shown to be effective in the animal assays. It is recognized that the method of treatment may comprise a single administration of a therapeutically effective amount or multiple administrations of a therapeutically effective amount of the IL-35R agonist or antagonist.
- formulations comprising an effective amount of a pharmaceutical composition of the invention comprising IL-35R agonists or antagonists can be used for the purpose of treatment, prevention, and diagnosis of a number of clinical indications related to the activity of the IL-35R complex.
- compositions suitable for administration can be incorporated into pharmaceutical compositions suitable for administration.
- Such compositions typically comprise the nucleic acid molecule, protein, or antibody and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
- pharmaceutically acceptable carrier is intended to include any and all solvents, dispersion media, coatings, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, and the like, compatible with pharmaceutical administration. The use of such media and agents for pharmaceutically active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active compound, use thereof in the compositions is contemplated. Supplementary active compounds can also be incorporated into the compositions.
- a pharmaceutical composition of the invention is formulated to be compatible with its intended route of administration.
- routes of administration include parenteral, e.g., intravenous, intradermal, subcutaneous, oral (e.g., inhalation), transdermal (topical), transmucosal, and rectal administration.
- T R regulatory T
- administration can be by direct injection at the site (or former site) of a cancer that is to be treated.
- the therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition is delivered in a vesicle, such as liposomes (see, e.g., Langer, Science 249:1527-33, 1990 and Treat et al., in Liposomes in the Therapy of Infectious Disease and Cancer , Lopez Berestein and Fidler (eds.), Liss, N.Y., pp. 353-65, 1989).
- a vesicle such as liposomes
- the therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition can be delivered in a controlled release system.
- a pump can be used (see, e.g., Langer, Science 249:1527-33, 1990; Sefton, Crit. Rev. Biomed. Eng. 14:201-40, 1987; Buchwald et al., Surgery 88:507-16, 1980; Saudek et al., N Engl. J. Med. 321:574-79, 1989).
- polymeric materials can be used (see, e.g., Levy et al., Science 228:190-92, 1985; During et al., Ann. Neurol. 25:351-56, 1989; Howard et al., J. Neurosurg. 71:105-12, 1989).
- Other controlled release systems such as those discussed by Langer ( Science 249:1527-33, 1990), can also be used.
- Solutions or suspensions used for parenteral, intradermal, or subcutaneous application can include the following components: a sterile diluent such as water for injection, saline solution, fixed oils, polyethylene glycols, glycerine, propylene glycol or other synthetic solvents; antibacterial agents such as benzyl alcohol or methyl parabens; antioxidants such as ascorbic acid or sodium bisulfite; chelating agents such as ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid; buffers such as acetates, citrates or phosphates and agents for the adjustment of tonicity such as sodium chloride or dextrose. pH can be adjusted with acids or bases, such as hydrochloric acid or sodium hydroxide.
- the parenteral preparation can be enclosed in ampoules, disposable syringes, or multiple dose vials made of glass or plastic.
- compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersions.
- suitable carriers include physiological saline, bacteriostatic water, Cremophor EL ⁇ (BASF; Parsippany, N.J.), or phosphate buffered saline (PBS).
- the composition must be sterile and should be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi.
- the carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyetheylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof.
- the proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion, and by the use of surfactants.
- Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be achieved by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, ascorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
- isotonic agents for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, sodium chloride, in the composition.
- Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent that delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
- Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
- dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
- the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying, which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
- Oral compositions generally include an inert diluent or an edible carrier. They can be enclosed in gelatin capsules or compressed into tablets. For the purpose of oral therapeutic administration, the active compound can be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of tablets, troches, or capsules. Oral compositions can also be prepared using a fluid carrier for use as a mouthwash, wherein the compound in the fluid carrier is applied orally and swished and expectorated or swallowed. Pharmaceutically compatible binding agents, and/or adjuvant materials can be included as part of the composition.
- the tablets, pills, capsules, troches and the like can contain any of the following ingredients, or compounds of a similar nature: a binder such as microcrystalline cellulose, gum tragacanth, or gelatin; an excipient such as starch or lactose, a disintegrating agent such as alginic acid, Primogel, or corn starch; a lubricant such as magnesium stearate or Sterotes; a glidant such as colloidal silicon dioxide; a sweetening agent such as sucrose or saccharin; or a flavoring agent such as peppermint, methyl salicylate, or orange flavoring.
- a suitable propellant e.g., a gas such as carbon dioxide, or a nebulizer.
- Systemic administration can also be by transmucosal or transdermal means.
- penetrants appropriate to the barrier to be permeated are used in the formulation.
- penetrants are generally known in the art, and include, for example, for transmucosal administration, detergents, bile salts, and fusidic acid derivatives.
- Transmucosal administration can be accomplished through the use of nasal sprays or suppositories.
- the active compounds are formulated into ointments, salves, gels, or creams as generally known in the art.
- the compounds can also be prepared in the form of suppositories (e.g., with conventional suppository bases such as cocoa butter and other glycerides) or retention enemas for rectal delivery.
- the active compounds are prepared with carriers that will protect the compound against rapid elimination from the body, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems.
- a controlled release formulation including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems.
- Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Methods for preparation of such formulations will be apparent to those skilled in the art.
- the materials can also be obtained commercially from Alza Corporation and Nova Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
- Liposomal suspensions (including liposomes targeted to infected cells with monoclonal antibodies to viral antigens) can also be used as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. These can be prepared according to methods known to those skilled in the art, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,522,811.
- Dosage unit form refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subject to be treated with each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active compound calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical carrier.
- the specification for the dosage unit forms of the invention are dictated by and directly dependent on the unique characteristics of the active compound and the particular therapeutic effect to be achieved, and the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such an active compound for the treatment of individuals.
- compositions can be included in a container, pack, or dispenser together with instructions for administration.
- sequence identity or “identity” in the context of two polynucleotides or polypeptide sequences makes reference to the residues in the two sequences that are the same when aligned for maximum correspondence over a specified comparison window.
- sequence identity or “identity” in the context of two polynucleotides or polypeptide sequences makes reference to the residues in the two sequences that are the same when aligned for maximum correspondence over a specified comparison window.
- percentage of sequence identity is used in reference to proteins it is recognized that residue positions which are not identical often differ by conservative amino acid substitutions, where amino acid residues are substituted for other amino acid residues with similar chemical properties (e.g., charge or hydrophobicity) and therefore do not change the functional properties of the molecule.
- sequences differ in conservative substitutions the percent sequence identity may be adjusted upwards to correct for the conservative nature of the substitution.
- Sequences that differ by such conservative substitutions are said to have “sequence similarity” or “similarity”. Means for making this adjustment are well known to those of skill in the art. Typically this involves scoring a conservative substitution as a partial rather than a full mismatch, thereby increasing the percentage sequence identity. Thus, for example, where an identical amino acid is given a score of 1 and a non-conservative substitution is given a score of zero, a conservative substitution is given a score between zero and 1. The scoring of conservative substitutions is calculated, e.g., as implemented in the program PC/GENE (Intelligenetics, Mountain View, Calif.).
- percentage of sequence identity means the value determined by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over a comparison window, wherein the portion of the polynucleotide sequence in the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions (i.e., gaps) as compared to the reference sequence (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences. The percentage is calculated by determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid base or amino acid residue occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the window of comparison, and multiplying the result by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
- sequence identity/similarity values provided herein refer to the value obtained using GAP Version 10 using the following parameters: % identity and % similarity for a nucleotide sequence using GAP Weight of 50 and Length Weight of 3, and the nwsgapdna.cmp scoring matrix; % identity and % similarity for an amino acid sequence using GAP Weight of 8 and Length Weight of 2, and the BLOSUM62 scoring matrix; or any equivalent program thereof.
- equivalent program is intended any sequence comparison program that, for any two sequences in question, generates an alignment having identical nucleotide or amino acid residue matches and an identical percent sequence identity when compared to the corresponding alignment generated by GAP Version 10.
- mice C57BL/6 (wild type), CD4.cre, and IL12R ⁇ 2 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were purchased from the Jackson Laboratory. Gp130 floxed knockin mice were provided by Rodger McEver at Oklahoma Medical Research Foundation. gp130 fl ⁇ CD4.cre ⁇ IL12Rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ were obtained by breeding the three mouse strains listed. All animal experiments were performed in American Association for the Accreditation of Laboratory Animal Care-accredited, specific-pathogen-free facilities in the St. Jude Animal Resource Center following national, state and institutional guidelines. Animal protocols were approved by the St Jude Animal Care and Use Committee.
- T eff (CD4 + CD25 ⁇ CD45RB hi ) from the spleens and lymph nodes of C57BL/6 or knockout age-matched gp130.fl ⁇ CD4.cre ⁇ IL12Rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were positively sorted by FACS. After red blood cell lysis, cells were stained with antibodies against CD4, CD25 and CD45RB and purified on a MoFlo cell sorter.
- IL-35 constructs were generated by recombinant PCR and cloned into pPlGneo, a pCIneo-based vector (Promega) that we have modified to include an IRES-GFP cassette.
- HEK293T cells were transfected using 10 ⁇ g plasmid per 2 ⁇ 10 6 cells using Trans IT transfection reagent. Cells were sorted for equivalent GFP expression and were cultured for 36 hours to facilitate protein secretion. Dialyzed, filtered supernatant from cells was used as the source of IL-35 in IL-35 mediated suppression assays.
- iTr35 are an induced regulatory T cell population that is generated by treatment with IL-35 and suppress via IL-35. See, U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/156,995, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety.
- Purified murine T eff cells were activated by anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of IL-35 supernatant, at 25% of total culture medium, to induce “conversion” of T eff cells into iT R 35. Following conversion, iT R 35 were purified for use in suppression assays.
- T eff were activated for 72 hours with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of IL-35 supernatant as 25%, 12.5%, or 6.25% of culture media.
- iT R 35 were purified and assayed for their capacity to suppress freshly sorted T eff cell proliferation. Cultures were pulsed with 1 mCi [ 3 H]-thymidine for the final 8 hours of the 72 hour assay, and were harvested with a Packard Micromate cell harvester. Counts per minute were determined using a Packard Matrix 96 direct counter. Percent suppression was calculated using the following formula: ((cpm of T eff cells alone ⁇ cpm of T eff cells treated with IL-35 or iT R 35)/cpm of T eff cells alone)*100.
- FIG. 1 shows that wild-type T eff proliferation is potently suppressed by IL-35 in a titratable manner.
- IL-35 is unable to suppress the proliferation of T eff cells that lack the IL-35R (gp130.fl ⁇ CD4.cre ⁇ IL12Rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ ).
- iT R 35 suppression of T eff cell proliferation is dependent upon IL-35.
- IL-35R deficient T eff cells are resistant to suppression mediated by iT R 35.
- mice Spleens and lymph nodes from Il12rb1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were provided by D. Fairweather and J. A. Frisancho (Johns Hopkins University), CD4 cre ⁇ gp130 fl/fl mice were provided by M. Karin and S. Grivennikov (University of California at San Diego), IL27ra ⁇ / ⁇ mice were provided by C. Hunter and J. Stumhofer (University of Pennsylvania), Stat1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were provided by A. Satoskar and P. Reville (Ohio State University), and Stat3 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were provided by C. Drake and H.R. Yen (Johns Hopkins University).
- IL12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ , Stat4 ⁇ / ⁇ , Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ , C57BL/6, B6.PL and Balb/c mice were purchased from the Jackson Laboratory. All animal experiments were performed in American Association for the Accreditation of Laboratory Animal Care-accredited, specific-pathogen-free facilities in the St. Jude Animal Resource Center following national, state and institutional guidelines. Animal protocols were approved by the St. Jude Animal Care and Use Committee.
- Neutralizing IL-35 mAb was developed by immunization with recombinant murine Ebi3 protein. Briefly, recombinant murine Ebi3 was cloned and expressed in a proprietary E. coli expression system developed by Mike Jones (Shenandoah Biotechnology) and used for immunization of Ebi3 ⁇ / ⁇ mice. Clones V1.4F5.29, V1.4H6.25, and V1.4C4.22 were subsequently chosen for their capacity to IP, blot, and specifically neutralize IL-35 bioactivity.
- IL-35 constructs were generated by recombinant PCR and cloned into pPlGneo, a pCIneo-based vector (Promega) that has been modified to include an IRES-GFP cassette.
- a construct containing Ebi3 and 1112a linked by a flexible glycine-serine linker was used for IL-35 generation and an empty pPlGneo vector was used as a control.
- HEK293T cells were transfected using 10 ⁇ g plasmid per 2 ⁇ 10 6 cells using TransIT transfection reagent (Mirus).
- Transfection media was exchanged for fresh culture media after 24 hours and were cultured for an additional 36 hours to facilitate protein secretion. Dialyzed, filtered supernatant from cells was used at 25% of total culture medium to induce conversion of T conv cells into iT R 35 or iT R control cells.
- Anti-CD3/CD28-coated latex beads 4 ⁇ M sulfate latex beads (Molecular Probes) were incubated overnight at room temperature with rotation in a 1:4 dilution of anti-CD3+ anti-CD28 antibody mix (13.3 ⁇ g/ml anti-CD3 (murine clone #145-2c11, human clone #OKT3) (eBioscience) and 26.6 ⁇ g/ml anti-CD28 (murine clone #37.51, human clone #CD28.6) (eBioscience). Beads were washed 3 times with 5 mM phosphate buffer pH 6.5 and resuspended at 5 ⁇ 10 7 /ml in sterile phosphate buffer with 2 mM BSA.
- IL-35 beads Recombinant IL-35 beads. Beads were generated that presented IL-35 to cells in a manner that excluded use of 293T supernatants. Anti-p35 mAb clone 25806 (R&D Systems) or isotype control (rat IgG2) mAb was added to 1 ml of IL-35 supernatant or control supernatant and rotated at 4° C. for 4 hours. Protein G beads were added and rotated for an additional 12-18 hours. To ensure the protein was attached to the beads, the beads were boiled to release bound protein, resolved by SDS-PAGE and probed with anti-Ebi3 mAb. Both the beads and post IP supernatant were tested for functional activity in a standard suppression assay. Beads were cultured with T conv in medium containing anti-CD3+ anti-CD28 conjugated beads as indicated for 3 days. Proliferation was determined by [ 3 H]-thymidine incorporation.
- T conv purification, iT R 35 conversion and suppressed T conv , cell generation T conv (CD4 + CD25 ⁇ CD45RB hi ) and T reg) (CD4 + CD25 + CD45RB lo cells from the spleens and lymph nodes of C57BL/6 or knockout age-matched mice were positively sorted by FACS. After red blood cell lysis, cells were stained with antibodies against CD4, CD25 and CD45RB (Biolegend) and sorted on a MoFlo (Dako) or Reflection (i-Cyt). Murine iT R 35 cells were generated.
- purified murine T conv cells from wild-type or indicated knockout mice were activated by anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of 25% culture medium from control or IL-35 transfected 293T cells (dialyzed against media and filtered) to generate murine iT R 35.
- purified T conv cells were activated in the presence of anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads and T regs at a 4:1 (T conv :T reg ratio) for 72 hours.
- Suppressed T conv from the co-culture were re-sorted on the basis of congenic markers and used for qPCR analysis of receptor expression.
- iT R 35-mediated control of homeostatic expansion homeostatic expansion.
- Homeostasis assays were performed.
- Naive Thy1.2 + T conv cells were isolated by FACS from wild-type or knockout mice (as indicated) and used as “responder” cells in adoptive transfer.
- Thy1.1 + iT R 35 were generated as described above and used as “suppressor” cells in adoptive transfer.
- T conv cells (2 ⁇ 10 6 ) with or without suppressor cells (5 ⁇ 10 5 ) were resuspended in 0.5 ml of PBS plus 2% FBS, and were injected intravenously through the tail vein into Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice. Mice were euthanized seven days post transfer, and splenocytes were counted, stained and analyzed by flow cytometry using antibodies against Thy1.1 and Thy1.2 (BD Bioscience). For each group, 5-10 mice were analyzed.
- B16 tumor model For T cell adoptive transfer experiments using the B16 melanoma model, Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice received indicated cells via the tail vein on day ⁇ 1 of experiment. Wild type or receptor deficient na ⁇ ve CD4 + CD25 ⁇ (9 ⁇ 10 6 /mouse) and CD8 + T cells (6 ⁇ 10 6 /mouse) alone or in combination with iT R 35 cells (10 6 /mouse) were adoptively transferred into mice.
- B16-F10 melanoma was a gift from Mary Jo Turk (Dartmouth College, Hanover, N.H.) and was passaged intradermally (i.d.) in C57/B16 mice 5 times to ensure reproducible growth.
- B16 cells were cultured in RPMI 1640 containing 7.5% FBS and washed three times with RPMI prior to injections if viability exceeded 96%.
- Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice were injected with 120,000 cells on the right flank i.d.
- B16 tumor diameters were measured daily with calipers and reported as mm 3 (a 2 ⁇ b/2, where “a” is the smaller caliper measurement and “b” the larger).
- B16 tumors were excised at day 14 when tumor size was 5-10 mm in diameter. For each group, 4-5 mice were analyzed.
- the IL35 receptor comprises IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130.
- T conv were treated with or without rIL-27 for 18 hours prior to analysis of receptor expression and proliferation.
- RNA was extracted, cDNA generated and qPCR performed. Cytokine treated cells were mixed at indicated concentrations of IL-35 for 3 days. Proliferation was determined by [ 3 H]-thymidine incorporation.
- IL-35 can suppress the proliferation of both Il27ra ⁇ / ⁇ and Il12rb1 ⁇ / ⁇ T covnv cells to a degree similar to that seen in wild-type T conv cells (data not shown).
- T conv cells that lack expression of either IL12R ⁇ 2 (Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ ) or gp130 (CD4 crc ⁇ gp130 fl/fl ; referred to herein as gp130 ⁇ T ) are partially resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression.
- Generation of Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ and CD4 crc ⁇ gp130′′ mice results in T conv cells that are completely resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression.
- cytokines that signal through the gp130 chain including LIF, OncM and CNTF, require leukocyte inhibitory factor- ⁇ (LIFR ⁇ ) in addition to gp130 and the specificity-determining receptor chain.
- LIFR ⁇ leukocyte inhibitory factor- ⁇
- T conv cells T conv cells, the targets of IL-35 signaling, do not express LIFR ⁇ , therefore it doesn't appear to be important for IL-35 signaling.
- IL-35 conjugated via an anti-p35 specific mAb, or isotype control mAb, to Protein G beads was utilized as suppressors of T conv cell proliferation.
- Isotype control or non-neutralizing anti-IL35 mAb were incubated with IL-35 supernatant and then coupled with protein G beads.
- the protein G coupled beads were then incubated with T conv cells activated in presence of a CD3 and a CD28.
- T conv sorted from indicated wild-type or receptor deficient T conv cells were activated in the presence of wild-type Tregs and proliferation determined by [ 3 H]-thymidine incorporation.
- nTreg, or T conv cells mixed at a 4:1 ratio were activated in the presence of anti-CD3-CD28-coated beads in the top chamber of a TranswellTM culture plate.
- Responder T conv were activated with anti-CD3-CD28-coated beads in the bottom chamber of the plates. Proliferation of the responder T conv cells in the bottom chambers was determined. No suppression of proliferation was detected in isotype control beads, regardless of genotype. However, as seen with both IL-35 protein and iT R 35, suppression was limited in IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp 130 deficient T conv cells and completely absent in T conv cells that lack both IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130.
- T regs that lack IL-35 expression (Ebi3 ⁇ / ⁇ or Il12a ⁇ / ⁇ ) are partially defective both in vitro and in vivo (Collison et al. (2007) Nature 450:566-569). Therefore, it was expected that T conv cells that lack the IL-35R and, thus, are unable to respond to IL-35, would be partially resistant to T reg -mediated suppression. Indeed, gp130 ⁇ T , Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ and IL35R ⁇ T T conv cells are all partially resistant to T reg mediated suppression of proliferation (data not shown).
- T conv cells activated in the presence of T reg are potently suppressive across a permeable membrane in an IL-35-dependent manner (Collison et al. (2009). J. Immunol. 182:6121-6128). Therefore, in addition to a standard suppression assay, it was also determined whether IL35R ⁇ T T conv were suppressed across a permeable membrane. While wild-type T conv cells were potently suppressed by co-cultured T conv and T reg , IL35R ⁇ T T conv cells were completely resistant to iT R 35 mediated suppression (data not shown).
- iT R 35 a novel induced T reg population, iT R 35 , has been described that suppresses the proliferation of T conv cells exclusively via IL-35 (Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101). Both exogenously added IL-35 and T reg cells induce conversion of T conv cells to iT R 35 in vitro, and in vivo, under inflammatory conditions. Given that their mode of suppression is by way of IL-35, they represent a perfect tool for determining cell-mediated suppression via IL-35. Therefore, it was assessed whether iT R 35 suppressed the proliferation of each of the receptor deficient T conv cells.
- T conv cells that lacked expression of either IL12R ⁇ 2 or gp130 were partially resistant and cells that lacked both IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130 were completely resistant to iT R 35 mediated suppression (data not shown).
- neutralizing mAb to IL-35, but not an isotype control completely blocked the suppressive capacity of iT R 35 of wild-type T conv cells.
- IL35R-Deficient T conv Cells are Resistant to IL-35 Mediated Suppression In Vivo.
- iT R 35 can control the homeostatic expansion of T conv cells in the lymphopenic environment of the recombination activating gene-1 (Rag1) ⁇ / ⁇ mouse.
- iT R 35 cells significantly limited the proliferation of wild-type, gp130 ⁇ T, Il 27ra ⁇ / ⁇ , Il12rb1 ⁇ / ⁇ ,Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35R ⁇ T Thy1.2 + T conv cells.
- iT R 35 cells failed to block the expansion of IL35R ⁇ T Thy1.1 +T conv cells ( FIG. 2A ).
- IL-35 signaling in vivo is abrogated only by loss of both IL12R ⁇ 2 and gp130 expression.
- iT R 35 can block the anti-tumor CD8 + T cell response against B16 melanoma.
- Wild-type, gp130 ⁇ T , Il27ra ⁇ / ⁇ , Il12rb1 ⁇ / ⁇ , Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ or IL35R ⁇ T CD4 + and CD8 + T cells, either alone or in the presence of iT R 35 cells were adoptively transferred into Rag1 ⁇ / ⁇ mice. The following day, mice were inoculated intradermally with B 16 melanoma cells and tumor size was monitored daily and reported after 14 days.
- tumor burden was similar between mice receiving all CD4 + and CD8 + T cells, regardless of genotype ( FIG. 2B ).
- Tumor size was exacerbated in mice receiving iT R 35 cells in combination with wild-type, gp130 ⁇ T , Il27ra ⁇ / ⁇ , Il12rb1 ⁇ / ⁇ , and Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ CD4 + and CD8 + T cells.
- IL35R ⁇ T recipients were completely resistant to iT R 35 mediated prevention of tumor immunity.
- T conv cells were activated in the presence of T reg at a 4:1 ratio (responder:suppressor) for 72 hours.
- RNA was extracted and cDNA generated from resting or activated T conv cells or from suppressed T conv cells from T conv :T reg co-cultures (resorted based on differential Thy1 markers). Relative gp130, Il27ra, Il12rb1 and Il12rb2 mRNA expression was determined.
- IL-12 treatment of T conv cells resulted in phosphorylation of STAT4 and IL-27 signaling induced STAT1 and STAT3 phosphorylation (data not shown).
- wild-type T conv cells which are responsive to IL-35 mediated suppression, demonstrated phosphorylation of both STAT1 and STAT4, but no activation of either STAT3 or STAT5.
- no induction of p-STAT1 or p-STAT4 was seen in T conv cells that lack the IL-35 receptor (Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ ⁇ gp130 ⁇ T T conv , hence forth referred to as IL35R ⁇ T ) (data not shown).
- T conv cells were activated for 24 hours with anti-CD3+anti-CD28 coated beads and treated with IL-35 for indicated times.
- Western blot analysis demonstrated that p-STAT1 was the most dramatic, with maximal phosphorylation evident at 30 minutes. Similar to STAT3 and STAT5, STAT4 phosphorylation was less pronounced, but was sustained over the course of time analyzed.
- T conv cells that lack STAT1, STAT3, or STAT4 were utilized.
- IL-35 can suppress the proliferation of Stat3 ⁇ / ⁇ T conv cells to a degree similar to that seen in wild-type T conv cells.
- suppression of Stat1 ⁇ / ⁇ and Stat4 ⁇ / ⁇ T conv , cells was reduced (data not shown).
- T reg -mediated suppression of both Stat1 ⁇ / ⁇ and Stat4 ⁇ / ⁇ T conv cells was impaired (data not shown).
- Reduced signaling in Stat1 ⁇ / ⁇ and Stat4 ⁇ / ⁇ T conv cells is not due to lack of receptor expression as mRNA expression of receptor chains is similar in Stat1 ⁇ / ⁇ , Stat4 ⁇ / ⁇ and wild-type T conv cells (data not shown).
- IL-35 is a Target of the IL-35 Signaling Pathway.
- IL-35 can convert proliferative, IL35 T conv cells into hypo-responsive, strongly suppressive iT R 35 which express and mediate suppression via IL-35 (Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101).
- Activation of wild-type T conv in the presence of IL-35 significantly upregulated Ebi3 and 1112a mRNA, the two components of IL-35 (Ebi3 and p35, respectively).
- Ebi3 and p35 the two components of IL-35.
- gp130 ⁇ T , Il12rb2 ⁇ / ⁇ and IL35R ⁇ T T conv cells are all resistant to induction of Ebi3 expression ( FIG. 3A ).
- gp130 ⁇ T T conv cells retain the ability to upregulate 1112a expression in response to IL-35 treatment, suggesting that p35 expression may be downstream of IL12R ⁇ 2 signaling.
- Induction of IL-35 expression in response to IL-35 treatment is critical for conversion of T conv cells into iT R 35 . Therefore, the ability of receptor deficient mice to be converted into iT R 35 was assessed.
- To determine whether IL-35 treated T conv cells had acquired regulatory capacity they were co-cultured as suppressors with freshly purified responder T conv cells ( FIG. 3B ). T conv cells treated with control protein, regardless of genotype, were incapable of suppressing responder T conv cell proliferation.
- IL-12 IL-12 receptor and signaling pathway overlap with that of IL-12 and IL-27.
- IL-35 appears to be able to signal, in part, through each of the receptor chains, IL-12R ⁇ 2 and gp130. This is likely due to the fact that each of these chains is the signal transducing subunit of their respective cytokine receptors.
- IL-35 signals primarily through two different STAT proteins, STAT1 and STAT4.
- STAT3 appears dispensable for IL-35 signaling, an interesting observation given its importance for IL-27 signaling, which is downstream of gp130 engagement.
- STAT1/STAT3 heterodimers have been previously described yet there is no precedent for STAT1/STAT 4 heterodimerization.
- the expression pattern of the IL-35 receptor also provides insight into potential IL-35 target cell types. While gp130 is fairly ubiquitously expressed, both IL-12R chains are expressed mainly by activated T cells and NK cells. In T cells, the expression of IL-12R ⁇ 2 is confined to Th1 cells, and its expression correlates with responsiveness to IL-12 and presumably IL-35. Expression of IL-12R ⁇ 2 has also been shown on other cell types, such as dendritic cells which would vastly affect the scope of IL-35 bioactivity in the immune system.
- IL-12R ⁇ 2 is undetectable on most resting T cells, but can be rapidly upregulated by exposure to IL-12, IL-27, IFN- ⁇ , tumor-necrosis factor (TNF) and co-stimulation through CD28.
- IL35 might have biological effects on a variety of cellular targets and under a variety of disease conditions.
- IL-35 appears to utilize receptor chains and STATs that are similar to those used by other IL-12 family members, another important question is how a T cell can translate potentially similar signals into such distinct biological outcomes. Given the opposing activities of IL-35 and IL-12, IL-23, and IL-27, it is possible that different kinetics, binding affinities, or potentially as yet unidentified heterodimerization patterns may differentiate the signaling pathways in such a way to mediate such diverse biological consequences.
Landscapes
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Immunology (AREA)
- Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
- Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Biochemistry (AREA)
- Zoology (AREA)
- Biophysics (AREA)
- Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
- Pathology (AREA)
- Cell Biology (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- Microbiology (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Toxicology (AREA)
- Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
- Hematology (AREA)
- Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
- Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
- Oncology (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Tropical Medicine & Parasitology (AREA)
- Food Science & Technology (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
Abstract
The receptor for Interleukin 35 (IL-35) is provided. The Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interluekin12Rβ2 receptor and the gp130 receptor. Various compositions comprising the IL-35R complex, along with polynucleotides encoding the same and kits and methods for the detection of the same the same are provided. Methods of modulating the activity of IL-35R or modulating effector T cell functions are also provided. Such methods employ various IL-35R antagonists and agonists that modulate the activity of the IL-35R complex and, in some embodiments, modulate effector T cell function. Further provided are methods for screening for IL-35R binding agents and for IL-35R modulating agents. Various methods of treatment are further provided.
Description
- The present invention relates to methods for regulating T cell function in a subject, particularly effector T cell activity.
- The official copy of the sequence listing is submitted concurrently with the specification as a text file via EFS-Web, in compliance with the American Standard Code for Information Interchange (ASCII), with a file name of 397057SEQLIST.txt, a creation date of Nov. 16, 2010, and a size of 61 KB. The sequence listing filed via EFS-Web is part of the specification and is hereby incorporated in its entirety by reference herein.
- The immune system provides the human body with a means to recognize and defend itself against microorganisms, viruses, and substances recognized as foreign and potentially harmful. Classical immune responses are initiated when antigen-presenting cells present an antigen to CD4+ T helper (Th) lymphocytes resulting in T cell activation, proliferation, and differentiation of effector T lymphocytes. Following exposure to antigens, such as that which results from infection or the grafting of foreign tissue, naïve T cells differentiate into Th1 and Th2 cells with differing functions. Th1 cells produce interferon gamma (IFN-γ) and interleukin 2 (IL-2) (both associated with cell-mediated immune responses). Th1 cells play a role in immune responses commonly involved in the rejection of foreign tissue grafts as well as many autoimmune diseases. Th2 cells produce cytokines such as interleukin-4 (IL-4), and are associated with antibody-mediated immune responses such as those commonly involved in allergies and allergic inflammatory responses such as allergic rhinitis and asthma. Th2 cells may also contribute to the rejection of foreign grafts. In numerous situations, this immune response is desirable, for example, in defending the body against bacterial or viral infection, inhibiting the proliferation of cancerous cells and the like. However, in other situations, such effector T cells are undesirable, e.g., in a graft recipient.
- Whether the immune system is activated by or tolerized to an antigen depends upon the balance between T effector cell activation and T regulatory cell activation. T regulatory cells are responsible for the induction and maintenance of immunological tolerance. Regulatory T cells actively suppress the proliferation and cytokine production of Th1, Th2, or naïve cells which have been stimulated in culture with an activating signal (e.g., antigen and antigen presenting cells or with a signal that mimics antigen in the context of MHC, e.g., anti-CD3 antibody, plus anti-CD28 antibody).
- Undesirable immune responses have generally been treated with immunosuppressive drugs, which inhibit the entire immune system, i.e., both desired and undesired immune responses. General immunosuppressants must be administered frequently, for prolonged periods of time, and have numerous harmful side effects. Withdrawal of these drugs generally results in relapse of disease. Thus, there is a need for agents that preferentially modulate either the effector or the regulatory arm of the immune system.
- The receptor for Interleukin 35 (IL-35) is provided. The Interleukin-35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interleukin-12Rβ2 receptor (Il12rb2) and the gp130 receptor (also known as Interleukin-6 signal transducer, Il6st). Various compositions comprising the IL-35R complex, along with polynucleotides encoding the same and kits and methods for the detection of the same are provided.
- Methods of modulating the activity of IL-35R or modulating effector T cell functions are provided. Such methods employ various IL-35R antagonists and agonists that modulate the activity of the IL-35R complex and, in some embodiments, modulate effector T cell function. Further provided are methods for screening for IL-35R binding agents and for IL-35R modulating agents. Various methods of treatment are further provided.
-
FIG. 1 demonstrates that T-cells that lack both the Interluekin12Rβ2 receptor (IL12Rβ2) and the gp130 receptor are completely resistant to suppression mediated by IL-35 or iTr35, an induced regulatory T cell population that suppresses via IL-35. -
FIG. 2 demonstrates that IL35R deficient Tconv are resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression in vivo. Homeostatic expansion was monitored by i.v. injection of Thy1.2+ Tconv cells from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130ΔT (gp130 deficient in T cells), Il12rb2−/− or IL35RAT (gp130ΔT/Il12rb2−/−) mice alone or with Thy1.1+iT R35 cells (as regulatory cells) into Rag1−/− mice. Seven days after transfer, splenic T cell numbers were determined by flow cytometry. (B) Rag1−/− mice received CD4+ and CD8+ T cells from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130ΔT, Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔT mice alone or with iTR 35 cells via the tail vein on day −1 of the experiment. Onday 0, all were injected with 120,000 B16 cells i.d. in the right flank. Tumor diameter was measured daily for 14 days and is reported as mm3. Data represent the mean±SEM of 5-12 mice per group. -
FIG. 3 demonstrates that IL35 is a target of the IL35 signaling pathway. (A) Tconv purified by FACS from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130ΔT (gp130 deficient in T cells), Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔT (gp130ΔT Il12rb2−/−) mice were activated with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads for 18 hours in the presence of IL-35. RNA was extracted, cDNA generated and qPCR performed. Relative Ebi3 (left panel) and Il12a (right panel) mRNA expression. (B) Tconv from wild-type (C57BL/6), gp130ΔT, Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔT mice were activated in the presence of IL-35 or control protein at 25% of total culture volume, for 72 hours to generate iTR 35 or iTRcon cells, respectively. Cells were re-purified and mixed at indicated ratios (Tconv: suppressor) and proliferation was determined by [3H]-thymidine incorporation. Counts per minute of Tconv cells activated alone were 29,000-48,000 (b). Data represent the mean±SEM of 3-5 independent experiments. - The receptor for Interleukin 35 (IL-35) is provided. As demonstrated herein, the Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprises a heterodimeric complex of the Interluekin12Rβ2 receptor (IL12Rβ2) and the gp130 receptor.
- As used herein, the Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) refers to any intramolecular complex or single molecule comprising at least one gp130 polypeptide component or biologically active variant or fragment thereof and at least one IL12Rβ2 polypeptide component or biologically active variant or fragment thereof. Typically, in vivo, gp130 and IL12Rβ2 associate via a non-covalent association. For purposes of the present invention, the IL12Rβ2 and gp130 components may be associated with one another either covalently or non-covalently. In some examples, gp130 and IL12Rβ2 can be co-expressed as a fusion protein.
- Biologically active fragments and variants of the IL-35R complex are also provided. Such IL-35R complexes comprise an active variant or fragment of gp130 and/or an active variant or fragment of IL12Rβ2 and will retain at least one activity of the IL-35R complex.
- The phrase “biological activity of IL-35R” refers to one or more of the biological activities of IL-35R, including but not limited to, (1) interacting with its ligand, IL-35; (2) activating any of the STAT pathways including the STAT1 and/or STAT4 pathways; (3) IL-35 dependent suppression of effector T-cell function, including for example, suppression of proliferation, cytokine secretion and/or differentiation; and/or (4) autocrine induction of IL-35 expression by IL-35. Such assays can be found, for example, in Collison et al. (2007) Nature 450:566-569; Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101.
- As discussed above, the IL-35R complex interacts with the ligand, IL-35. As used herein, “Interleukin 35” or “IL-35” refers to any intramolecular complex or single molecule comprising at least one EBI3 polypeptide component and at least one p35 polypeptide component. See, for example, International Patent Application No. PCT/US2007/079310, filed Sep. 24, 2007, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. EBI3 and p35 are known in the art. The human EBI3 gene encodes a protein of about 33 kDa. The protein shares about 27% sequence identity to the p40 subunit of human IL12. Nucleic acid and amino acid sequences for EBI3 are known. See, for example, SEQ ID NOs:1 and 2 of WO97/13859 (human) and GenBank Accession Numbers NM015766 and BC046112 (mouse). Nucleic acid and amino acid sequences for p35 are also known in the art and include SEQ ID NOs:3 and 4 of WO97/13859 (human) and GenBank Accession Numbers NM—000882 and M86672 (mouse). The term IL-35 encompasses naturally occurring variants of IL-35, e.g., splice variants, allelic variants, and other isoforms. The term also encompasses fragments or variants of a native IL-35 such that the active variants and fragment continue to bind and allow for the activation of IL-35R.
- It is recognized that an IL-35R complex can be encoded on a single polynucleotide. For example, in one embodiment, a polynucleotide comprising a nucleotide sequence encoding an
Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex is provided and comprises a first sequence encoding the gp130 polypeptide or an active fragment or variant thereof; and a second sequence encoding the IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or an active fragment or variant thereof, wherein said encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex. In another embodiment, the IL-35R complex is encoded on distinct polynucleotides. Thus, a mixture of recombinant expression constructs encoding the various components of the IL-35R complex are further provided. - i. IL12Rβ2 Polynucleotides and Polypeptides
- The polypeptides that interact to form the IL-35R complex are known in the art. As used herein, the terms “Interleukin12Rβ2 receptor”, “IL12Rβ2” or “IL-12R-beta2” can be used interchangeably and refer to a family of cell surface receptors which can homodimerize or heterodimerize and display interleukin receptor activity and have now been shown herein to be a subunit of the IL-35R complex. Non-limiting examples of IL12Rβ2 polypeptides comprise the human IL12Rβ2 polynucleotide as set forth in SEQ ID NO:4, 5, and 6 (from GenBank Accession No. NM—001559.2) and can be found in GenBank Accession No. P40189.
- IL12Rβ2 polypeptides comprise a variety of conserved structural motifs. For ease of reference, such motifs will be discussed as they relate to the
human IL12Rβ2 isoform 1 which is set forth in SEQ ID NO:6. IL12Rβ2 polypeptides comprise an extracellular domain (from about amino acids 24-522 of SEQ ID NO:6); a transmembrane domain (from about amino acids 623-643 of SEQ ID NO:3), and an intercellular domain (from about amino acids 644-862 of SEQ ID NO:6). Additional conserved domains and motifs that have been characterized in the IL12Rβ2 polypeptides include a signal peptide (from about amino acids 1-23 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III I domain (from about amino acids 124-218 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 2 domain (from about amino acids 224-316 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 3 domain (from about amino acids 317-415 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 4 domain (from about amino acids 420-517 of SEQ ID NO:6), a Fibronectin type III 5 domain (from about amino acids 521-617 of SEQ ID NO:6), a motif involved with STAT4 binding (from about amino acids 796-801 of SEQ ID NO:6), a WSXWS motif (from about amino acids 305-309 of SEQ ID NO:6) which appears to be involved in proper protein folding and thereby efficient intracellular transport and cell-surface receptor binding, and aBox 1 motif (from about amino acids 662-670 of SEQ ID NO:6) which is involved in JAK interaction and/or activation. Glycosylation can occur at amino acid positions 48, 129, 166, 195, 271, 347, 376, and 480 of SEQ ID NO:6. - It is recognized that biologically active variants and fragments of the IL12Rβ2 polypeptide can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention. Such active variants and fragments will contain an IL-35R receptor activity when complexed with the gp130 partner. Variants of IL12Rβ2 are known including, but not limited to, an alternative sequence from aa 650-659 of SEQ ID NO:6 replacing VFVLLAALRP with RRHSCPWTGS; an alternative sequence from aa 660-862 of SEQ ID NO:6 is missing; the Rat aa 149 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with Q; the I at aa 185 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with V; the T at aa 201 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with I; the R at aa 313 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with G; the G at aa 420 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with R; the Q at aa 426 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with H; the G at aa 465 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with D; the A at aa 625 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with V; the H at aa 720 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with R; the L at aa 808 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with R; the Y at aa 678 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with F; or the Y at aa 767 of SEQ ID NO:6 is replaced with F.
- In specific embodiments, fragments of IL12Rβ2 are employed which comprise the extracellular domain of the IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant of the extracellular domain of IL12Rβ2. Such biologically active variants and fragments of the IL12Rβ2 extracellular domain will retain the ability to complex with the gp130 binding partner's extracellular domain and upon complex formation, the gp130/IL12Rβ2 complex will interact with the IL-35 ligand. Methods to assay for such binding are known.
- Thus, in one embodiment, the IL12Rβ2 polypeptide comprises the amino acid sequence as shown in SEQ ID NO:6 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof. Further provided are polynucleotides comprising the nucleotide sequence encoding a IL12Rβ2 polypeptide including the nucleotide sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:4 or 5 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
- ii. Gp130 Polynucleotides and Polypeptides
- As used herein, the terms “gp130”, “Interleukin-6-receptor subunit beta”, “IL-6R-beta”, “Interleukin-6-signal transducer”, “membrane glycoprotein 130”, “CDW130”,
- “Oncostatin-M receptor alpha subunit”, “CD_antigen=CD130” or IL6ST” can be used interchangeably and refer to a family of cell surface receptors which can homodimerize or heterodimerize and display interleukin receptor activity and have now been shown herein to be a subunit of the IL-35R complex. Non-limiting examples of gp130 polypeptides comprising the human gp130 polynucleotide and polypeptide are set forth in SEQ ID NOs: 1, 2, and 3 (GenBank Accession No. NP—002184.2) or also in GenBank Accession No. P40189.
- The gp130 polypeptide comprises a variety of conserved structural motifs and belongs to the type I cytokine receptor family. For ease of reference, such motifs will be discussed as they relate to the
human gp130 isoform 1 which is set forth in SEQ ID NO:3. gp130 polypeptides comprise an extracellular domain (from about amino acids 23-619 of SEQ ID NO:3); a transmembrane domain (from about amino acids 260-641 of SEQ ID NO:3), and an intercellular domain (from about amino acids 642-918 of SEQ ID NO:3). Additional conserved domains and motifs have been characterized in the gp130 polypeptides include a signal peptide (from about amino acids 1-22 of SEQ ID NO:3), an IG-like C2-type domain (from about amino acids 26-120 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III I domain (from about amino acids 125-216 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 2 domain (from about amino acids 222-321 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 3 domain (from about amino acids 326-418 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 4 domain (from about amino acids 423-514 of SEQ ID NO:3), a Fibronectin type III 5 domain (from about amino acids 518-610 of SEQ ID NO:3), a WSXWS motif (from about amino acids 310-314 of SEQ ID NO:3) which appears to be involved in proper protein folding and thereby efficient intracellular transport and cell-surface receptor binding, a Box 1 motif (from about amino acids 651-659 of SEQ ID NO:3) which is involved in JAK interaction and/or activation, and a compositional bias that is Ser-rich (from about amino acids 725-755 of SEQ ID NO:3). Glycosylation can occur at amino acid positions 43, 83, 131, 157, 227, 379, 383, 553, 564 of SEQ ID NO:3. Modified phosphoserine residues can occur at amino acids 667, 782, 820, and 829 of SEQ ID NO:3. Disulfide bonds can occur between amino acids 28 and 54, 48 and 103, 134 and 144, 172 and 182, and 458 and 466 of SEQ ID NO:3. - It is recognized that biologically active variants and fragments of the gp130 polypeptide can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention. Such active variants and fragments will continue to retain an IL-35R activity when complexed with the IL12Rβ2 partner. Variants and fragments of gp130 polypeptides and polynucleotides are known including, but not limited to, an alternative sequence from aa 325-329 of SEQ ID NO:3 replacing RPSKA with NIASF; an alternative sequence from aa 330-918 of SEQ ID NO:3 is missing; the T at aa 415 of SEQ ID NO:3 is replaced with I; or the S at aa 782 of SEQ ID NO:3 is replaced with A.
- In specific embodiments, fragments of the gp130 are employed which comprise the extracellular domain of the gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant of the extracellular domain of gp130. Such biologically active variants and fragments of the extracellular domain of gp130 will retain the ability to complex with the IL12Rβ2 binding partner's extracellular domain and upon complex formation, the gp130/IL12Rβ2 complex can interact with the IL-35 ligand. Methods to assay for such binding are known.
- Thus, in one embodiment, the gp130 polypeptide comprises the amino acid sequence as shown in SEQ ID NO:3 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof. Further provided are polynucleotides comprising the nucleotide sequence encoding a gp130 polypeptide including the nucleotide sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:1 or 2 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof
- iii. Variants and Fragments
- Fragments and variants of the polynucleotides encoding the gp130 and IL12Rβ2 polypeptides can be employed in the various methods and compositions of the invention. By “fragment” is intended a portion of the polynucleotide and hence the protein encoded thereby or a portion of the polypeptide. Fragments of a polynucleotide may encode protein fragments that retain the biological activity of the native protein and hence have IL-35R activity when complexed with the appropriate binding partner. Thus, fragments of a polynucleotide may range from at least about 20 nucleotides, about 50 nucleotides, about 100 nucleotides, about 150, about 200, about 250, about 300, about 350, about 400, about 450, about 500, about 550, about 600 and up to the full-length polynucleotide encoding the gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide.
- A fragment of a polynucleotide that encodes a biologically active portion of a gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide will encode at least 15, 25, 30, 50, 100, 150, 200, or 250 contiguous amino acids, or up to the total number of amino acids present in a full-length gp130 and IL12Rβ2 polypeptide.
- A biologically active portion of a gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide can be prepared by isolating a portion of one of the polynucleotides encoding the portion of the gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide and expressing the encoded portion of the polypeptide (e.g., by recombinant expression in vitro), and assessing the activity of the portion of the gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide. Polynucleotides that encode fragments of a gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptide can comprise nucleotide sequence comprising at least 16, 20, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, 800, 900, 1,000, 1,100, 1,200, 1,300, or 1,400 nucleotides, or up to the number of nucleotides present in a full-length gp130 and IL12Rβ2 nucleotide sequence disclosed herein.
- “Variant” sequences have a high degree of sequence similarity. For polynucleotides, conservative variants include those sequences that, because of the degeneracy of the genetic code, encode the amino acid sequence of one of the gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptides. Variants such as these can be identified with the use of well-known molecular biology techniques, as, for example, polymerase chain reaction (PCR) and hybridization techniques. Variant polynucleotides also include synthetically derived nucleotide sequences, such as those generated, for example, by using site-directed mutagenesis but which still encode a gp130 or a IL12Rβ2 polypeptide. Generally, variants of a particular polynucleotide will have at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity to that particular polynucleotide as determined by sequence alignment programs and parameters described elsewhere herein.
- Variants of a particular polynucleotide can also be evaluated by comparison of the percent sequence identity between the polypeptide encoded by a variant polynucleotide and the polypeptide encoded by the reference polynucleotide. Thus, for example, isolated polynucleotides that encode a polypeptide with a given percent sequence identity to the gp130 and IL12Rβ2 polypeptides set forth herein. Percent sequence identity between any two polypeptides can be calculated using sequence alignment programs and parameters described. Where any given pair of polynucleotides is evaluated by comparison of the percent sequence identity shared by the two polypeptides they encode, the percent sequence identity between the two encoded polypeptides is at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity.
- By “variant” protein is intended a protein derived from the native protein by deletion (so-called truncation) or addition of one or more amino acids to the N-terminal and/or C-terminal end of the native protein; deletion or addition of one or more amino acids at one or more sites in the native protein; or substitution of one or more amino acids at one or more sites in the native protein. Variant proteins are biologically active, that is they continue to possess the desired biological activity of the native protein, that is, IL-35R activity. Such variants may result from, for example, genetic polymorphism or from human manipulation. Biologically active variants of a gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptides will have at least about 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or more sequence identity to the amino acid sequence for the native protein as determined by sequence alignment programs and parameters described elsewhere herein. A biologically active variant of a protein may differ from that protein by as few as 1-15 amino acid residues, as few as 1-10, such as 6-10, as few as 5, as few as 4, 3, 2, or even 1 amino acid residue.
- Proteins may be altered in various ways including amino acid substitutions, deletions, truncations, and insertions. Methods for such manipulations are generally known in the art. For example, amino acid sequence variants of the gp130 or IL12Rβ2 proteins can be prepared by mutations in the DNA. Methods for mutagenesis and nucleotide sequence alterations are well known in the art. See, for example, Kunkel (1985) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 82:488-492; Kunkel et al. (1987) Methods in Enzymol. 154:367-382; U.S. Pat. No. 4,873,192; Walker and Gaastra, eds. (1983) Techniques in Molecular Biology (MacMillan Publishing Company, New York) and the references cited therein. Guidance as to appropriate amino acid substitutions that do not affect biological activity of the protein of interest may be found in the model of Dayhoff et al. (1978) Atlas of Protein Sequence and Structure (Natl. Biomed. Res. Found., Washington, D.C.), herein incorporated by reference. Conservative substitutions, such as exchanging one amino acid with another having similar properties, may be preferable.
- Thus, the polynucleotides used in the invention can include the naturally occurring sequences, the “native” sequences, as well as mutant forms. Likewise, the proteins used in the methods of the invention encompass naturally occurring proteins as well as variations and modified forms thereof. Such variants will continue to possess the ability to implement a recombination event. Generally, the mutations made in the polynucleotide encoding the variant polypeptide should not place the sequence out of reading frame, and/or create complementary regions that could produce secondary mRNA structure. See, EP Patent Application Publication No. 75,444.
- The deletions, insertions, and substitutions of the protein sequences encompassed herein are not expected to produce radical changes in the characteristics of the protein. However, when it is difficult to predict the exact effect of the substitution, deletion, or insertion in advance of doing so, one skilled in the art will appreciate that the effect will be evaluated by routine screening assays.
- Variant polynucleotides and proteins also encompass sequences and proteins derived from a mutagenic and recombinogenic procedure such as DNA shuffling. With such a procedure, one or more different gp130 or IL12Rβ2 coding sequences can be manipulated to create a new gp130 or IL12Rβ2 polypeptides possessing the desired properties. In this manner, libraries of recombinant polynucleotides are generated from a population of related sequence polynucleotides comprising sequence regions that have substantial sequence identity and can be homologously recombined in vitro or in vivo. Strategies for such DNA shuffling are known in the art. See, for example, Stemmer (1994) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91:10747-10751; Stemmer (1994) Nature 370:389-391; Crameri et al. (1997) Nature Biotech. 15:436-438; Moore et al. (1997) J. Mol. Biol. 272:336-347; Zhang et al. (1997) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 94:4504-4509; Crameri et al. (1998) Nature 391:288-291; and U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,605,793 and 5,837,458.
- iv. IL-35R Binding and/or Modulating Agents
- 1. Modulating Agents
- As used herein, the term “modulating” includes “inducing”, “inhibiting”, “potentiating”, “elevating”, “increasing”, “decreasing” or the like. Each of these terms denote a quantitative difference between two states and in particular, refer to at least a statistically significant difference between the two states.
- The term “IL-35R agonist” refers to an agent which potentiates, induces or otherwise enhances one or more of the biological properties of the IL-35R complex. The activity increases by a statistically significant amount including, for example, an increase of at least about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 95% or 100% of the activity of the IL-35R complex compared to an appropriate control.
- The term “IL-35R antagonist” refers to an agent which reduces, inhibits, or otherwise diminishes one or more of the biological activities of the IL-35R complex. Antagonism using the IL-35R antagonist does not necessarily indicate a total elimination of the IL-35R activity. Instead, the activity could decrease by a statistically significant amount including, for example, a decrease of at least about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 95% or 100% of the activity of the IL-35R complex compared to an appropriate control.
- By “specific modulating agent” is intended an agent that modulates the activity of a defined target. Thus, an IL-35R specific modulating agent modulates the biological activity of IL-35R by a statically significant amount (i.e., at least 5%, 10%, 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 100% or greater) and the agent does not modulate the biological activity of any monomeric subunits, homodimeric complexes or non-IL-35R heterodimeric complexes which comprise either IL12Rβ2 or gp130 by a statistically significant amount (i.e., the activity is modulated by less than 5%, 4%, 3%, 2% or 1%). One of skill will be aware of the proper controls that are needed to carry out such a determination. An IL-35R specific modulating agent may or may not be an IL-35R specific binding agent.
- In one non-limiting embodiment, the IL-35R modulating agent comprises a soluble IL-35R complex. Such a soluble complex is an IL-35R. As used herein, a “soluble IL-35R complex” comprises an IL-35R polypeptide that is incapable of anchoring itself in a membrane. Such soluble IL-35R polypeptides include, for example, a complex of gp130 and/or IL12Rβ2 polypeptides that lack a sufficient portion of their membrane spanning domain to anchor the IL-35R to the membrane or such polypeptides are modified such that the membrane spanning domain is non-functional. For example, a soluble fragment of a gp130 polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of gp130, including a fragment of the extracellular domain that is at least 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 90, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 590 or greater consecutive amino acids of gp130. A soluble fragment of an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of IL12Rβ2, including a fragment of the extracellular domain that is at least 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 90, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 495 or greater consecutive amino acids of IL12Rβ2. In specific embodiments, the soluble IL-35R complex binds IL-35. In other embodiments, the extracellular domains of gp130 and IL12Rβ2 that are present in the soluble form of the IL-35R complex share at least 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% to the amino acid sequence or the polynucleotide sequences as set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6. The soluble IL-35R complex find further use in stabilizing IL-35 (increasing half-life) or acting to concentrate IL-35.
- A soluble IL-35R complex can additionally include a second moiety. The second moiety can be any chemical compound. In specific embodiments, the second moiety adds in the detection of the soluble complex or promotes the overall solubility of the complex. Such moieties include, but are not limited to, an immunoglobulin chain, a GST, Lex-A or MBP polypeptide sequence. For example, a fusion protein can includes at least a fragment of an IL-35R complex, which is capable of binding IL-35, wherein the IL-35R complex comprises a soluble fragment of a gp130 (e.g., a fragment of gp130 comprising the extracellular domain of gp130) and a soluble fragment of IL12Rβ2 (e.g., a fragment of IL12Rβ2 comprising the extracellular domain of IL12Rβ2) wherein at least one of the gp130 fragment, the IL12Rβ2 fragment, or both are fused to a second moiety. In specific embodiments, the second moiety comprises an immunoglobulin chain, an Fc fragment (CH2, hinge, CH3 constant region domains), a heavy chain constant region domain of the various isotypes, including: IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4, IgM, IgA1, IgA2, IgD, and IgE).
- A soluble form of the IL-35R complex can be generated using various protein motifs that assist in complex formation. One such motif comprises a leucine zipper motif. Leucine zipper domains are peptides that promote oligomerization of the polypeptides in which they are found. Leucine zippers were originally identified in several DNA-binding polypeptides (Landschulz et al. (1988) Science 240:1759), and have since been found in a variety of different polypeptides. Among the known leucine zippers are naturally occurring peptides and derivatives thereof that dimerize or trimerize. The zipper domain (also referred to herein as an oligomerizing, or oligomer-forming, domain) comprises a repetitive heptad repeat, often with four or five leucine residues interspersed with other amino acids. Use of leucine zippers and preparation of oligomers using leucine zippers are well known in the art. Any other method which assists in the stabilization of the soluble complex can be employed.
- It is recognized that a soluble IL-35R complex can be encoded on a single polynucleotide. For example, in one embodiment, a polynucleotide comprising a nucleotide sequence encoding a
soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex is provides and comprise a first sequence encoding the extracellular domain of gp130, an active fragment or variant thereof; and a second sequence encoding the extracellular domain of IL12Rβ2, active fragment or variant thereof, the encoded soluble polypeptide complex bind IL-35. In another embodiment, the soluble IL-35R complex is encoded on distinct polynucleotides. - In another embodiment, a “specific modulating agent” can comprise an agent, such as an antibody, which modulates the ability of the IL-35R to be activated by IL-35 but permits the IL-35R complex to be activated by other non-IL-35 ligands. Such agents can be IL-35R binding agents, a gp130 binding agent, or an IL12Rβ2 binding agent.
- 2. IL-35R Binding Agents As used herein, an “IL-35R binding agent” refers to any compound that directly interacts with or binds to the IL-35R complex. By “specific binding agent” is intended an agent that binds substantially only to a defined target. Thus, an IL-35R specific binding agent interacts directly with IL-35R and binds substantially only to epitopes which are formed upon the interaction of IL12Rβ2 and gp130 to form the biologically active IL-35R. Thus, an IL-35R specific binding agent will not substantially interact with monomeric protein subunits comprising IL12Rβ2 or gp130 and the agent will not substantially interact with homodimeric or non-IL-35R heterodimeric complexes which comprise IL12Rβ2 or gp130 in a statistically significant amount. By “specifically or selectively binds to an IL-35R complex” is intended that the binding agent has a binding affinity for a non-IL-35R epitope which is less than 10%, 9%, 8%, 7%, 6%, 5%, 4%, 3%, 2% or 1% of the binding affinity for the unique IL-35R epitope. One of skill will be aware of the proper controls that are needed to carry out such a determination. An IL-35R specific binding agent may or may not modulate the activity of IL-35R.
- By “IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent” is intended an agent that possesses the properties of both an IL-35R specific binding agent and an IL-35R specific modulating agent. The IL-35R specific binding and/or modulating agent can be an IL-35R agonist or an IL-35R antagonist.
- By “IL-35 activation” is intended any activity resulting from the binding of IL-35 to the IL-35R complex. As used herein, an agent that “specifically inhibits” IL-35 activity of the IL-35R complex will substantially block the activity of IL-35R by IL-35, but will not significantly block the activity of IL-35R by a non-IL-35 ligand.
- In one embodiment, the IL-35R binding and/or modulating agent is a small molecule. For example, such small molecules include, but are not limited to, peptides, peptidomimetics, amino acids, amino acid analogs, polynucleotides, polynucleotide analogs, nucleotides, nucleotide analogs, organic or inorganic compounds (i.e., including heterorganic and organometallic compounds).
- 3. Anti-IL-35R Antibodies
- As noted herein, the invention includes antibodies that specifically bind to the IL-35R complex. Antibodies, including monoclonal antibodies (mAbs), can be made by standard protocols. See, for example, Harlow and Lane, Using Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, CSHL, New York, 1999. Briefly, a mammal such as a mouse, hamster or rabbit can be immunized with an immunogenic form of a peptide. Techniques for conferring immunogenicity on a protein or peptide include conjugation to carriers or other techniques, well known in the art. In preferred embodiments, the subject antibodies are immunospecific for the unique antigenic determinants of IL-35R.
- As discussed herein, these antibodies are collectively referred to as “anti-IL-35R antibodies”. Thus, by “anti-IL-35R antibodies” is intended antibodies specific for IL-35R. All of these antibodies are encompassed by the discussion herein. The respective antibodies can be used alone or in combination in the methods of the invention.
- By “antibodies that specifically bind” is intended that the antibodies will not substantially cross react with another polypeptide. By “not substantially cross react” is intended that the antibody or fragment has a binding affinity for a non-homologous protein which is less than 10%, less than 5%, or less than 1%, of the binding affinity for the IL-35R complex.
- In specific embodiments, the anti-IL-35R antibody binds specifically to IL-35R and further modulates the activity of the IL-35R complex. Thus, in specific embodiments, the anti-IL-35R antibody is an IL-35R agonist or is an IL-35R antagonist.
- The anti-IL-35R antibodies disclosed herein and for use in the methods of the present invention can be produced using any antibody production method known to those of skill in the art. Thus, polyclonal sera may be prepared by conventional methods. In general, a solution containing the IL-35R complex or an active variant or fragment thereof is first used to immunize a suitable animal, preferably a mouse, rat, rabbit, or goat. Rabbits or goats are preferred for the preparation of polyclonal sera due to the volume of serum obtainable, and the availability of labeled anti-rabbit and anti-goat antibodies.
- Polyclonal sera can be prepared in a transgenic animal, preferably a mouse bearing human immunoglobulin loci. In a preferred embodiment, Sf9 (Spodoptera frugiperda) cells expressing IL-35R are used as the immunogen Immunization can also be performed by mixing or emulsifying the antigen-containing solution in saline, preferably in an adjuvant such as Freund's complete adjuvant, and injecting the mixture or emulsion parenterally (generally subcutaneously or intramuscularly). A dose of 50-200 μg/injection is typically sufficient Immunization is generally boosted 2-6 weeks later with one or more injections of the protein in saline, preferably using Freund's incomplete adjuvant. One may alternatively generate antibodies by in vitro immunization using methods known in the art, which for the purposes of this invention is considered equivalent to in vivo immunization. Polyclonal antisera are obtained by bleeding the immunized animal into a glass or plastic container, incubating the blood at 25° C. for one hour, followed by incubating at 4° C. for 2-18 hours. The serum is recovered by centrifugation (e.g., 1,000×g for 10 minutes). About 20-50 ml per bleed may be obtained from rabbits.
- Production of the Sf9 cells is disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,004,552. Briefly, sequences encoding IL-35R complex are recombined into a baculovirus using transfer vectors. The plasmids are co-transfected with wild-type baculovirus DNA into Sf9 cells. Recombinant baculovirus-infected Sf9 cells are identified and clonally purified.
- Preferably the antibody is monoclonal in nature. By “monoclonal antibody” is an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, that is, the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible naturally occurring mutations that may be present in minor amounts. The term is not limited regarding the species or source of the antibody. The term encompasses whole immunoglobulins as well as fragments such as Fab, F(ab′)2, Fv, and others which retain the antigen binding function of the antibody. Monoclonal antibodies are highly specific, being directed against a single antigenic site on the target polypeptide. Furthermore, in contrast to conventional (polyclonal) antibody preparations that typically include different antibodies directed against different determinants (epitopes), each monoclonal antibody is directed against a single determinant on the antigen. The modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method. For example, the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the present invention may be made by the hybridoma method first described by Kohler and Milstein (Nature 256:495-97, 1975), or may be made by recombinant DNA methods (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567). The “monoclonal antibodies” may also be isolated from phage antibody libraries using the techniques described in, for example, Clackson et al. (Nature 352:624-28, 1991), Marks et al. (J. Mol. Biol. 222:581-97, 1991) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,548.
- By “epitope” is the part of an antigenic molecule to which an antibody is produced and to which the antibody will bind. Epitopes can comprise linear amino acid residues (i.e., residues within the epitope are arranged sequentially one after another in a linear fashion), nonlinear amino acid residues (referred to herein as “nonlinear epitopes”—these epitopes are not arranged sequentially), or both linear and nonlinear amino acid residues.
- As discussed herein, mAbs can be prepared using the method of Kohler and Milstein, or a modification thereof. Typically, a mouse is immunized with a solution containing an antigen. Immunization can be performed by mixing or emulsifying the antigen-containing solution in saline, preferably in an adjuvant such as Freund's complete adjuvant, and injecting the mixture or emulsion parenterally. Any method of immunization known in the art may be used to obtain the monoclonal antibodies of the invention. After immunization of the animal, the spleen (and optionally, several large lymph nodes) are removed and dissociated into single cells. The spleen cells may be screened by applying a cell suspension to a plate or well coated with the antigen of interest. The B cells expressing membrane bound immunoglobulin specific for the antigen bind to the plate and are not rinsed away. Resulting B cells, or all dissociated spleen cells, are then induced to fuse with myeloma cells to form hybridomas, and are cultured in a selective medium. The resulting cells are plated by serial dilution and are assayed for the production of antibodies that specifically bind the antigen of interest (and that do not bind to unrelated antigens). The selected mAb-secreting hybridomas are then cultured either in vitro (e.g., in tissue culture bottles or hollow fiber reactors), or in vivo (as ascites in mice).
- Where the anti-IL-35R antibodies of the invention are to be prepared using recombinant DNA methods, the DNA encoding the monoclonal antibodies is readily isolated and sequenced using conventional procedures (e.g., by using oligonucleotide probes that are capable of binding specifically to genes encoding the heavy and light chains of murine antibodies). The hybridoma cells described herein serve as a preferred source of such DNA. Once isolated, the DNA can be placed into expression vectors, which are then transfected into host cells such as E. coli cells, simian COS cells, Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) cells, or myeloma cells that do not otherwise produce immunoglobulin protein, to obtain the synthesis of monoclonal antibodies in the recombinant host cells. Review articles on recombinant expression in bacteria of DNA encoding an antibody includes Skerra, A. (Curr. Opinion in Immunol. 5:256-62, 1993) and Phickthun, A. (Immunol. Revs. 130:151-88, 1992). Alternatively, antibody can be produced in a cell line such as a CHO cell line, as disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,545,403; 5,545,405 and 5,998,144. Briefly the cell line is transfected with vectors capable of expressing a light chain and a heavy chain, respectively. By transfecting the two proteins on separate vectors, chimeric antibodies can be produced. Another advantage is the correct glycosylation of the antibody.
- Additionally, the term “anti-IL-35R antibody” as used herein encompasses chimeric and humanized anti-IL-35R antibodies. By “chimeric” antibodies is intended antibodies that are most preferably derived using recombinant deoxyribonucleic acid techniques and which comprise both human (including immunologically “related” species, e.g., chimpanzee) and non-human components. Thus, the constant region of the chimeric antibody is most preferably substantially identical to the constant region of a natural human antibody; the variable region of the chimeric antibody is most preferably derived from a non-human source and has the desired antigenic specificity to the IL-35R antigen. The non-human source can be any vertebrate source that can be used to generate antibodies to a human IL-35R antigen or material comprising a human IL-35R antigen. Such non-human sources include, but are not limited to, rodents (e.g., rabbit, rat, mouse, etc.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567) and non-human primates (e.g., Old World Monkeys, Apes, etc.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,750,105 and 5,756,096). As used herein, the phrase “immunologically active” when used in reference to chimeric/humanized anti-IL-35R antibodies means chimeric/humanized antibodies that bind human IL-35R.
- By “humanized” is intended forms of anti-IL-35R antibodies that contain minimal sequence derived from non-human immunoglobulin sequences. For the most part, humanized antibodies are human immunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a hypervariable region (also known as complementarity determining region or CDR) of the recipient are replaced by residues from a hypervariable region of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and capacity. The phrase “complementarity determining region” refers to amino acid sequences which together define the binding affinity and specificity of the natural Fv region of a native immunoglobulin binding site. See, for example, Chothia et al. (J. Mol. Biol. 196:901-17, 1987) and Kabat et al. (U.S. Dept. of Health and Human Services, NIH Publication No. 91-3242, 1991). The phrase “constant region” refers to the portion of the antibody molecule that confers effector functions.
- Humanization can be essentially performed following the methods described by Jones et al. (Nature 321:522-25, 1986), Riechmann et al. (Nature 332:323-27, 1988) and Verhoeyen et al. (Science 239:1534-36, 1988), by substituting rodent or mutant rodent CDRs or CDR sequences for the corresponding sequences of a human antibody. See also U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,225,539; 5,585,089; 5,693,761; 5,693,762; and 5,859,205. In some instances, residues within the framework regions of one or more variable regions of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues (see, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,585,089; 5,693,761; 5,693,762; and 6,180,370). Furthermore, humanized antibodies may comprise residues that are not found in the recipient antibody or in the donor antibody. These modifications are made to further refine antibody performance (e.g., to obtain desired affinity). In general, the humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the hypervariable regions correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin and all or substantially all of the framework regions are those of a human immunoglobulin sequence. The humanized antibody optionally also will comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin. Accordingly, such “humanized” antibodies may include antibodies wherein substantially less than an intact human variable domain has been substituted by the corresponding sequence from a non-human species.
- Also encompassed by the term “anti-IL-35R antibodies” are xenogeneic or modified anti-IL-35R antibodies produced in a non-human mammalian host, more particularly a transgenic mouse, characterized by inactivated endogenous immunoglobulin loci. In such transgenic animals, competent endogenous genes for the expression of light and heavy subunits of host immunoglobulins are rendered non-functional and substituted with the analogous human immunoglobulin loci. These transgenic animals produce human antibodies in the substantial absence of light or heavy host immunoglobulin subunits. See, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,877,397 and 5,939,598. Preferably, fully human antibodies to IL-35 can be obtained by immunizing transgenic mice. One such mouse is disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,075,181; 6,091,001; and 6,114,598.
- Fragments of the anti-IL-35R antibodies are suitable for use in the methods of the invention so long as they retain the desired affinity of the full-length antibody. Thus, a fragment of an anti-IL-35R antibody will retain the ability to specifically bind to IL-35R. Such fragments are characterized by properties similar to the corresponding full-length anti-IL-35R antibody; that is, the fragments will specifically bind IL-35R. Such fragments are referred to herein as “antigen-binding” fragments.
- Suitable antigen-binding fragments of an antibody comprise a portion of a full-length antibody, generally the antigen-binding or variable region thereof. Examples of antibody fragments include, but are not limited to, Fab, F(ab′)2, and Fv fragments and single-chain antibody molecules. By “Fab” is intended a monovalent antigen-binding fragment of an immunoglobulin that is composed of the light chain and part of the heavy chain. By F(ab′)2 is intended a bivalent antigen-binding fragment of an immunoglobulin that contains both light chains and part of both heavy chains. By “single-chain Fv” or “sFv” antibody fragments is intended fragments comprising the VH and VL domains of an antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain. See, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,946,778; 5,260,203; 5,455,030; and 5,856,456. Generally, the Fv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the VH and VL domains that enables the sFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding. For a review of sFv see Pluckthun, A. (1994) in The Pharmacology of Monoclonal Antibodies, Vol. 113, ed. Rosenburg and Moore (Springer-Verlag, New York), pp. 269-315.
- Antibodies or antibody fragments can be isolated from antibody phage libraries generated using the techniques described in, for example, McCafferty et al. (Nature 348:552-54, 1990) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,548. Clackson et al. (Nature 352:624-28, 1991) and Marks et al. (J. Mol. Biol. 222:581-97, 1991) describe the isolation of murine and human antibodies, respectively, using phage libraries. Subsequent publications describe the production of high affinity (nM range) human antibodies by chain shuffling (Marks et al., Bio/Technology 10:779-83, 1992), as well as combinatorial infection and in vivo recombination as a strategy for constructing very large phage libraries (Waterhouse et al., Nucleic. Acids Res. 21:2265-66, 1993). Thus, these techniques are viable alternatives to traditional monoclonal antibody hybridoma techniques for isolation of monoclonal antibodies.
- Various techniques have been developed for the production of antibody fragments. Traditionally, these fragments were derived via proteolytic digestion of intact antibodies (see, e.g., Morimoto et al., J. Biochem. Biophys. Methods 24:107-17, 1992 and Brennan et al., Science 229:81-3, 1985). However, these fragments can now be produced directly by recombinant host cells. For example, the antibody fragments can be isolated from the antibody phage libraries discussed above. Alternatively, Fab fragments can be directly recovered from E. coli and chemically coupled to form F(ab′)2 fragments (Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-67, 1992). According to another approach, F(ab′)2 fragments can be isolated directly from recombinant host cell culture. Other techniques for the production of antibody fragments will be apparent to the skilled practitioner.
- A representative assay to detect anti-IL-35R antibodies specific to the unique epitopes form upon complex formation of IL-35R is a “competitive binding assay.” Competitive binding assays are serological assays in which unknowns are detected and quantitated by their ability to inhibit the binding of a labeled known ligand to its specific antibody. Antibodies employed in such immunoassays may be labeled or unlabeled. Unlabeled antibodies may be employed in agglutination; labeled antibodies may be employed in a wide variety of assays, employing a wide variety of labels. Detection of the formation of an antibody-antigen complex between an anti-IL-35R antibody and an epitope of interest can be facilitated by attaching a detectable substance to the antibody. Suitable detection means include the use of labels such as radionucleotides, enzymes, coenzymes, fluorescers, chemiluminescers, chromogens, enzyme substrates or co-factors, enzyme inhibitors, prosthetic group complexes, free radicals, particles, dyes, and the like. Such labeled reagents may be used in a variety of well-known assays, such as radioimmunoassays, enzyme immunoassays, e.g., ELISA, fluorescent immunoassays, and the like. See, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,766,162; 3,791,932; 3,817,837; and 4,233,402.
- In still further embodiments, the antibody is bispecific, wherein a first antigen binding domain specifically interacts with an epitope of gp130 and said second antigen binding domain specifically interacts with an epitope of IL12Rβ2.
- Further provided is a mixture of a first and a second antibody. The mixture comprise a first antibody having a first chemical moiety and the first antibody binds substantially only to gp130 and a second antibody having a second chemical moiety and the second antibody bind substantially only to a second polypeptide comprising IL12Rβ2. The first and the second chemical moiety allow for the interaction of said first and said second antibody at an IL-35R complex to be detected. Methods for such forms of detection and chemical moieties of interest are discussed elsewhere herein.
- 4. Anti-gp130 and Anti-IL12Rβ2Antibodies
- The compositions further include antibodies that specifically bind to the constituents of the IL-35R complex: gp130 and IL12Rβ2. As described above, techniques for conferring immunogenicity on a protein or peptide include conjugation to carriers or other techniques, well known in the art. In preferred embodiments, anti-gp130 and anti-IL12Rβ2 antibodies are immunospecific for the unique antigenic determinants of gp130 and IL12Rβ2, respectively. The term “anti-gp130 antibody” as used herein encompasses an antibody that binds substantially only to a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, where the antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex. The term “anti-IL12Rβ2_antibody” as used herein encompasses an antibody that binds substantially only to an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, where such an antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex. In some embodiments, anti-gp130 and anti-IL12Rβ2_antibodies can be “specific modulating agents” which modulate the ability of the IL-35R to be activated by IL-35 but permit the IL-35R complex to be activated by other non-IL-35 ligands. Thus, in some embodiments, an anti-gp130 antibody can bind substantially only to a gp130 polypeptide, or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, and act as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R by substantially and specifically inhibiting IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex. In such cases, IL-35R activation by non-IL-35 ligands can include, for example, the binding of Interleukin 27 (IL-27) or interleukin 12 (IL-12) to the IL-35R complex. Methodologies provided herein for the production and use of anti-IL-35R antibodies can be adapted to make and use anti-gp130 and anti-IL12Rβ2 antibodies,
- vi. Expression Cassettes and Host Cells
- The various polynucleotides of the invention can be expressed in an expression cassette. An expression cassette comprises one or more regulatory sequences, selected on the basis of the cells to be used for expression, operably linked to the desired polynucleotide. “Operably linked” is intended to mean that the desired polynucleotide (i.e., gp130 and/or IL12Rβ2 or active variants and fragments thereof) is linked to the regulatory sequence(s) in a manner that allows for expression of the nucleotide sequence (e.g., in an in vitro transcription/translation system or in a cell when the expression cassette or vector is introduced into a cell). “Regulatory sequences” include promoters, enhancers, and other expression control elements (e.g., polyadenylation signals). See, for example, Goeddel (1990) in Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185 (Academic Press, San Diego, Calif.). Regulatory sequences include those that direct constitutive expression of a nucleotide sequence in many types of host cells, those that direct expression of the nucleotide sequence only in certain host cells (e.g., tissue-specific regulatory sequences), or those that direct expression of the polynucleotide in the presence of an appropriate inducer (inducible promoter). It will be appreciated by those skilled in the art that the design of the expression cassette can depend on such factors as the choice of the host cell to be transformed, the level of expression of the polynucleotide that is desired, and the like. Such expression cassettes typically include one or more appropriately positioned sites for restriction enzymes, to facilitate introduction of the nucleic acid into a vector.
- As used herein, “heterologous” in reference to a sequence is a sequence that originates from a foreign species, or, if from the same species, is substantially modified from its native form in composition and/or genomic locus by deliberate human intervention. For example, a promoter operably linked to a heterologous polynucleotide is from a species different from the species from which the polynucleotide was derived, or, if from the same/analogous species, one or both are substantially modified from their original form and/or genomic locus, or the promoter is not the native promoter for the operably linked polynucleotide. Alternatively, a sequence that is heterologous to a cell is a sequence that originates from a foreign species, or, if from the same species, is substantially modified in the cell from its native form in composition and/or genomic locus by deliberate human intervention.
- It will further be appreciated that appropriate promoter and/or regulatory elements can readily be selected to allow expression of the relevant transcription units in the cell of interest. In certain embodiments, the promoter utilized to direct intracellular expression of a silencing element is a promoter for RNA polymerase III (Pol III). References discussing various Pol III promoters, include, for example, Yu et al. (2002) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 99(9), 6047-6052; Sui et al. (2002) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 99(8), 5515-5520 (2002); Paddison et al. (2002) Genes and Dev. 16, 948-958; Brummelkamp et al. (2002) Science 296, 550-553; Miyagashi (2002) Biotech. 20, 497-500; Paul et al. (2002) Nat. Biotech. 20, 505-508; Tuschl et al. (2002) Nat. Biotech. 20, 446-448. According to other embodiments, a promoter for RNA polymerase I, e.g., a tRNA promoter, can be used. See McCown et al. (2003) Virology 313(2):514-24; Kawasaki (2003) Nucleic Acids Res. 31 (2):700-7.
- The regulatory sequences can also be provided by viral regulatory elements. For example, commonly used promoters are derived from polyoma,
Adenovirus 2, cytomegalovirus, andSimian Virus 40. For other suitable expression systems for both prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells, seeChapters 16 and 17 of Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.). See, Goeddel (1990) in Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185 (Academic Press, San Diego, Calif.). - Various constitutive promoters are known. For example, in various embodiments, the human cytomegalovirus (CMV) immediate early gene promoter, the SV40 early promoter, the Rous sarcoma virus long terminal repeat, rat insulin promoter and glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase can be used to obtain high-level expression of the coding sequence of interest. The use of other viral or mammalian cellular or bacterial phage promoters which are well-known in the art to help achieve expression of a coding sequence of interest. Promoters which may be used include, but are not limited to, the long terminal repeat as described in Squinto et al. (1991) Cell 65:1 20); the SV40 early promoter region (Bernoist and Chambon (1981) Nature 290:304 310), the CMV promoter, the M-
MuLV 5′ terminal repeat the promoter contained in the 3′ long terminal repeat of Rous sarcoma virus (Yamamoto et al. (1980) Cell 22:787 797), the herpes thymidine kinase promoter (Wagner et al. (1981) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 78:144 1445), the regulatory sequences of the metallothionine gene (Brinster et al. (1982) Nature 296:39 42); the following animal transcriptional control regions, which exhibit tissue specificity and have been utilized in transgenic animals: elastase I gene control region which is active in pancreatic acinar cells (Swift et al. (1984) Cell 38:639 646; Ornitz et al. (1986) Cold Spring Harbor Symp. Quant. Biol. 50:399 409; MacDonald, 1987, Hepatology Z:425 515); insulin gene control region which is active in pancreatic beta cells (Hanahan (1985) Nature 315:115 122), immunoglobulin gene control region which is active in lymphoid cells (Grosschedl et al. (1984) Cell 38:647 658; Adames et al (1985) Nature 318:533 538; Alexander et al. (1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:1436 1444), mouse mammary tumor virus control region which is active in testicular, breast, lymphoid and mast cells (Leder et al. (1986) Cell 45:485 495). - Inducible promoters are also known. Non-limiting examples of inducible promoters and their inducer inlcude MT II/Phorbol Ester (TPA) (Palmiter et al. (1982) Nature 300:611) and heavy metals (Haslinger and Karin (1985) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 82:8572; Searle et al. (1985) Mol. Cell. Biol. 5:1480; Stuart et al. (1985) Nature 317:828; Imagawa et al. (1987) Cell 51:251; Karin et al. (1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:606; Angel et al. (1987) Cell 49:729; McNeall et al. (1989) Gene 76:8); MMTV (mouse mammary tumor virus)/Glucocorticoids (Huang et al. (1981) Cell 27:245; Lee et al. (1981) Nature 294:228; Majors and Varmus (1983) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 80:5866; Chandler et al. (1983) Cell 33:489; Ponta et al. (1985) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 82:1020; Sakai et al. (1988) Genes and Dev. 2:1144); β-Interferon/poly(rI)X and poly(rc) (Tavernier et al. (1983) Nature 301:634);
Adenovirus 5 E2/E1A (Imperiale and Nevins (1984) Mol. Cell. Biol. 4:875); c-jun/Phorbol Ester (TPA), H2O2; Collagenase/Phorbol Ester (TPA) (Angel et al. (1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:2256); Stromelysin/Phorbol Ester (TPA), IL-1 (Angel et al. (1987) Cell 49:729); SV40/Phorbol Ester (TPA) (Angel et al. (1987) Cell 49:729); Murine MX Gene/Interferon, Newcastle Disease Virus; GRP78 Gene/A23187 (Resendez Jr. et al. (1988) Mol. Cell. Biol. 8:4579); α-2-Macroglobulin/IL-6; Vimentin/Serum (Kunz et al. (1989) Nucl. Acids Res. 17:1121); MHC Class I Gene H-2 kB/Interferon (Blanar et al. (1989) EMBO J. 8:1139); HSP70/E1a, SV40 Large T Antigen (Taylor and Kingston (1990) Mol. Cell. Biol. 10:165; Taylor and Kingston (1990) Mol. Cell. Biol. 10:176; Taylor et al. (1989) J. Biol. Chem. 264:15160); Proliferin/Phorbol Ester-TPA (Mordacq and Linzer (1989) Genes and Dev. 3:760); Tumor Necrosis Factor/PMA (Hensel et al. (1989) Lymphokine Res. 8:347); Thyroid Stimulating Hormone α Gene/Thyroid Hormone (Chatterjee et al. (1989) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA. 86:9114); and, Insulin E Box/Glucose. - Such expression cassettes can be contained in a vector which allow for the introduction of the expression cassette into a cell. In specific embodiments, the vector allows for autonomous replication of the expression cassette in a cell or may be integrated into the genome of a cell. Such vectors are replicated along with the host genome (e.g., nonepisomal mammalian vectors). In general, expression vectors of utility in recombinant DNA techniques are often in the form of plasmids (vectors). However, the invention is intended to include such other forms of expression vectors, such as viral vectors (e.g., replication defective retroviruses, adenoviruses, and adeno-associated viruses). See, for example, U.S. Publication 2005214851, herein incorporated by reference.
- Any expression cassette can further comprise a selection marker. As used herein, the term “selection marker” comprises any polynucleotide, which when expressed in a cell allows for the selection of the transformed cell with the vector. For example, a selection marker can confer resistance to a drug, a nutritional requirement, or a cytotoxic drug. A selection marker can also induce a selectable phenotype such as fluorescence or a color deposit. A “positive selection marker” allows a cell expressing the marker to survive against a selective agent and thus confers a positive selection characteristic onto the cell expressing that marker. Positive selection marker/agents include, for example, Neo/G418, Neo/Kanamycin, Hyg/Hygromycin, hisD/Histidinol, Gpt/Xanthine, Ble/Bleomycin, HPRT/Hypoxanthine. Other positive selection markers include DNA sequences encoding membrane bound polypeptides. Such polypeptides are well known to those skilled in the art and can comprise, for example, a secretory sequence, an extracellular domain, a transmembrane domain and an intracellular domain. When expressed as a positive selection marker, such polypeptides associate with the cell membrane. Fluorescently labeled antibodies specific for the extracellular domain may then be used in a fluorescence activated cell sorter (FACS) to select for cells expressing the membrane bound polypeptide. FACS selection may occur before or after negative selection.
- A “negative selection marker” allows the cell expressing the marker to not survive against a selective agent and thus confers a negative selection characteristic onto the cell expressing the marker. Negative selection marker/agents include, for example, HSV-tk/Acyclovir or Gancyclovir or FIAU, Hprt/6-thioguanine, Gpt/6-thioxanthine, cytosine deaminase/5-fluoro-cytosine, diphtheria toxin or the ricin toxin. See, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,464,764, herein incorporated by reference.
- In preparing an expression cassette or a homologous recombination cassette, the various DNA fragments may be manipulated, so as to provide for the DNA sequences in the proper orientation and, as appropriate, in the proper reading frame. Toward this end, adapters or linkers may be employed to join the DNA fragments or other manipulations may be involved to provide for convenient restriction sites, removal of superfluous DNA, removal of restriction sites, or the like. For this purpose, in vitro mutagenesis, primer repair, restriction, annealing, resubstitutions, e.g., transitions and transversions, may be involved.
- An “isolated” or “purified” polynucleotide or protein, or biologically active portion thereof, is substantially or essentially free from components that normally accompany or interact with the polynucleotide or protein as found in its naturally occurring environment. Thus, an isolated or purified protein is substantially free of other cellular material, or culture medium when produced by recombinant techniques, or substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized. An “isolated” polynucleotide is free of sequences (optimally protein encoding sequences) that naturally flank the polynucleotide (i.e., sequences located at the 5′ and 3′ ends of the polynucleotide) in the genomic DNA of the organism from which the polynucleotide is derived. For example, in various embodiments, the isolated polynucleotide can contain less than about 5 kb, 4 kb, 3 kb, 2 kb, 1 kb, 0.5 kb, or 0.1 kb of nucleotide sequence that naturally flank the polynucleotide in genomic DNA of the cell from which the polynucleotide is derived. A protein that is substantially free of cellular material includes preparations of protein having less than about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, or 1% (by dry weight) of contaminating protein. When the protein of the invention or biologically active portion thereof is recombinantly produced, optimally culture medium represents less than about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, or 1% (by dry weight) of chemical precursors or non-protein-of-interest chemicals.
- The use of the term “polynucleotide” is not intended to limit the present invention to polynucleotides comprising DNA. Those of ordinary skill in the art will recognize that polynucleotides, can comprise ribonucleotides and combinations of ribonucleotides and deoxyribonucleotides. Such deoxyribonucleotides and ribonucleotides include both naturally occurring molecules and synthetic analogues. The polynucleotides of the invention also encompass all forms of sequences including, but not limited to, single-stranded forms, double-stranded forms, hairpins, stem-and-loop structures, and the like.
- Any cell can be used in the methods and compositions. In specific embodiments, the cell is from a mammal, a primate, a human, a domestic animal or an agricultural animal. In specific embodiment, the cell is a non-human cell. Non-limiting animals that the cell can be derived from include cattle, sheep, goats, pigs, horses, rabbits, dogs, monkeys, cats, large felines (lions, tigers, etc.), wolves, mice, rats, rabbits, deer, mules, bears, cows, pigs, horses, oxen, zebras, elephants, and so on. The cell can further be from a plant, a worm (e.g., C. elegans), an insect, a fish, a reptile, an amphibian, a bird (including, but not limited to chickens, turkeys, ducks, geese and the like), a marsupial, etc. The cells can be derived from any tissue (diseased or healthy) from any of these organisms. Expression of IL-35R can be engineered to occur in any cell type that one would want to control growth or proliferation of, especially tumor cells or tissues/cells that are common targets of autoimmune diseases. Such host cells include cultured cells (in vitro), explants and primary cultures (in vitro and ex vivo).
- The present invention further provides transgenic animals expressing a first heterologous polynucleotide encoding gp130 or an active variant or fragment thereof and a second heterologous polynucleotide encoding an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- Such animals are useful as animal models having modulated IL-35R activity, including for example, animal models having modulated effector T cell function. In general, methods of generating transgenic animals and transformed cell lines are well known in the art (for example, see Grosveld et al., Transgenic Animals, Academic Press Ltd., San Diego, Calif. (1992)). Using the nucleotide sequences disclosed herein encoding gp130 and IL12Rβ2, a skilled artisan can readily generate transgenic animals and transformed cell lines which contain and express both heterologous sequences. Such animals serve as models for the development of alternative therapies for therapies that modulate effector T cell function.
- Such methods of the invention involve introducing a polypeptide or polynucleotide into a cell. “Introducing” is intended to mean presenting to the cell the polynucleotide or polypeptide in such a manner that the sequence gains access to the interior of a cell of the plant. The methods of the invention do not depend on a particular method for introducing a sequence into a cell, only that the polynucleotide or polypeptides gains access to the interior of a cell. Methods for introducing polynucleotide or polypeptides into various cell types are known in the art including, but not limited to, stable transformation methods, transient transformation methods, and virus-mediated methods.
- “Stable transformation” is intended to mean that the nucleotide construct introduced into a cell integrates into the DNA of the cell and is capable of being inherited by the progeny thereof “Transient transformation” is intended to mean that a polynucleotide is introduced into the cell and does not integrate into the genome of the cell or a polypeptide is introduced into a cell. Transformation protocols as well as protocols for introducing polypeptides or polynucleotide sequences into cell may vary depending on the type of cell targeted for transformation.
- Exemplary art-recognized techniques for introducing foreign polynucleotides into a host cell, include, but are not limited to, calcium phosphate or calcium chloride co-precipitation, DEAE-dextran-mediated transfection, lipofection, particle gun, or electroporation and viral vectors. Suitable methods for transforming or transfecting host cells can be found in U.S. Pat. No. 5,049,386, U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,787; and U.S. Pat. No. 4,897,355, Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.) and other standard molecular biology laboratory manuals. Various transfection agents can be used in these techniques. Such agent are known, see for example, WO 2005012487. One of skill will recognize that depending on the method by which a polynucleotide is introduced into a cell, the silencing element can be stably incorporated into the genome of the cell, replicated on an autonomous vector or plasmid, or present transiently in the cell.
- Viral vector delivery systems include DNA and RNA viruses, which have either episomal or integrated genomes after delivery to the cell. For a review of viral vector procedures, see Anderson (1992) Science 256:808-813; Haddada et al. (1995) Current Topics in Microbiology and Immunology Doerfler and Bohm (eds); and Yu et al. (1994) Gene Therapy 1:13-26. Conventional viral based systems for the delivery of polynucleotides could include retroviral, lentivirus, adenoviral, adeno-associated and herpes simplex virus vectors for gene transfer. Integration in the host genome is possible with the retrovirus, lentivirus, and adeno-associated virus gene transfer methods, often resulting in long term expression of the inserted transgene.
- The polynucleotide(s) encoding the IL-35R complex and active variants and fragments thereof, the IL-35R complex and active variants and fragments thereof, the soluble form of the IL-35R complex, the IL-35R specific binding and/or modulating agents, and the IL-35R agonist and antagonists disclosed herein can be used in one or more of the following methods: (a) screening assays; (b) detection assays; (c) predictive medicine (e.g., diagnostic assays, prognostic assays, monitoring clinical trials, and pharmacogenomics); and (d) methods of treatment (e.g., therapeutic and prophylactic).
- i. Methods to Screen for IL-35R Binding and/or Modulating
- The invention provides a method (also referred to herein as a “screening assay”) for identifying binding and/or modulating agents of IL-35R. As discussed above, identification of various IL-35R binding agents are of interest including agonist IL-35R binding agents, antagonist IL-35R binding agents, and IL-35R specific binding agents. Similarly, identification of various IL-35R modulating agents are of interest including, for example, IL-35R agonist and antagonists.
- The test compounds employed in the various screening assays can include any candidate compound including, for example, peptides, peptidomimetics, small molecules, antibodies, or other drugs. Such test compounds can be obtained using any of the numerous approaches in combinatorial library methods known in the art, including biological libraries, spatially addressable parallel solid phase or solution phase libraries, synthetic library methods requiring deconvolution, the “one-bead one-compound” library method, and synthetic library methods using affinity chromatography selection. The biological library approach is limited to peptide libraries, while the other four approaches are applicable to peptide, nonpeptide oligomer, or small molecule libraries of compounds (Lam (1997) Anticancer Drug Des. 12:145).
- Examples of methods for the synthesis of molecular libraries can be found in the art, for example in: DeWitt et al. (1993) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90:6909; Erb et al. (1994) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91:11422; Zuckermann et al. (1994). J. Med. Chem. 37:2678; Cho et al. (1993) Science 261:1303; Carrell et al. (1994) Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl. 33:2059; Carell et al. (1994) Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl. 33:2061; and Gallop et al. (1994) J. Med. Chem. 37:1233.
- Libraries of compounds may be presented in solution (e.g., Houghten (1992) Bio/Techniques 13:412-421), or on beads (Lam (1991) Nature 354:82-84), chips (Fodor (1993) Nature 364:555-556), bacteria (U.S. Pat. No. 5,223,409), spores (U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,571,698; 5,403,484; and 5,223,409), plasmids (Cull et al. (1992) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89:1865-1869), or phage (Scott and Smith (1990) Science 249:386-390; Devlin (1990) Science 249:404-406; Cwirla et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 87:6378-6382; and Felici (1991) J. Mol. Biol. 222:301-310).
- Determining the ability of the test compound to bind to the IL-35R complex can be accomplished, for example, by coupling the test compound with a radioisotope or enzymatic label such that binding of the test compound to the IL-35R complex or a biologically active portion thereof can be determined by detecting the labeled compound in a complex. For example, test compounds can be labeled with 125I, 35S, 14C, or 3H, either directly or indirectly, and the radioisotope detected by direct counting of radioemmission or by scintillation counting. Alternatively, test compounds can be enzymatically labeled with, for example, horseradish peroxidase, alkaline phosphatase, or luciferase, and the enzymatic label detected by determination of conversion of an appropriate substrate to product.
- In one embodiment, an assay is a cell-free assay comprising contacting an IL-35R complex or biologically active fragment or variant thereof with a test compound and determining the ability of the test compound to bind to the IL-35R complex or the biologically active variant or fragment thereof. Binding of the test compound to the IL-35R complex can be determined either directly or indirectly. An indirect assay could include assaying for a modulation in IL-35R activity. In a further embodiment, the test or candidate compound specifically binds to or selectively binds to the IL-35R complex.
- In another embodiment, the assay includes contacting the IL-35R complex or biologically active variant or fragment thereof with a known compound that binds to the IL-35R complex (such as its ligand, IL-35) to form an assay mixture, contacting the assay mixture with a test compound, and determining the ability of the test compound to preferentially bind to IL-35R complex or biologically active fragment or variant thereof as compared to the known compound.
- In another embodiment, an assay comprises contacting the IL-35R complex or biologically active portion thereof with a test compound and determining the ability of the test compound to modulate (e.g., stimulate or inhibit, act as an agonist or antagonist) the activity of the IL-35R complex or biologically active portion thereof. Determining the ability of the test compound to modulate the activity of an IL-35R complex can be accomplished, for example, by determining the ability of the IL-35R complex to bind to its ligand, IL-35, as described above, for determining direct binding. In an alternative embodiment, determining the ability of the test compound to modulate the activity of an IL-35R complex can be accomplished by determining the ability of the IL-35R complex to further modulate intercellular downstream pathways modulated by IL-35R. Such activities are discussed elsewhere herein.
- In some assays, it may be desirable to immobilize either an IL-35R complex or a biologically active fragment or variant thereof or the test compound to facilitate separation of complexed from uncomplexed forms of the IL-35R complex, as well as to accommodate automation of the assay. In one embodiment, a fusion protein can be provided that adds a domain that allows the IL-35R complex or active fragment or variant thereof or the test agent to be bound to a matrix. For example, glutathione-S-transferase/IL-35R complex fusion proteins or glutathione-S-transferase/IL-35R complex fusion proteins can be adsorbed onto glutathione sepharose beads (Sigma Chemical, St. Louis, Mo.) or glutathione-derivatized microtitre plates, which are then combined with the test compound, and the mixture incubated under conditions conducive to complex formation (e.g., at physiological conditions for salt and pH). Following incubation, the beads or microtitre plate wells are washed to remove any unbound components and complex formation is measured either directly or indirectly, for example, as described above.
- Other techniques for immobilizing proteins on matrices can also be used in the screening assays of the invention. For example, either the IL-35R complex or active fragment thereof or the test compound can be immobilized utilizing conjugation of biotin and streptavidin. Biotinylated IL-35R complexes or active fragments thereof or test agents can be prepared from biotin-NHS (N-hydroxy-succinimide) using techniques well known in the art (e.g., biotinylation kit, Pierce Chemicals, Rockford, Ill.), and immobilized in the wells of streptavidin-coated 96-well plates (Pierce Chemicals).
- In yet another aspect of the invention, the IL-35R complex can be used as “bait proteins” in a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al. (1993) Cell 72:223-232; Madura et al. (1993) J. Biol. Chem. 268:12046-12054; Bartel et al. (1993) Bio/Techniques 14:920-924; Iwabuchi et al. (1993) Oncogene 8:1693-1696; and PCT Publication No. WO 94/10300), to identify other proteins, which bind to or interact with the IL-35R complex or active fragments and variants thereof and, in some embodiments, modulate IL-35R complex activity.
- This invention further pertains to novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays and uses thereof for treatments as described herein.
- ii. Methods for Detecting
- Various methods and compositions for detecting and/or determining the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and IL12Rβ2 in a sample are provided. A biological sample can comprise any sample in which one desires to determine the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and IL12Rβ2 or one desires to detect or quantitate the level of the IL-35R complex. The term “biological sample” is intended to include tissues, cells, and biological fluids isolated from a subject, as well as tissues, cells, and fluids present within a subject. Detection of the expression of IL-35R in any cell type that expresses IL-35R can be performed, including expression levels in either diseased verses healthy tissue. That is, the detection method of the invention can be used to detect gp130 mRNA or genomic DNA, IL12Rβ2 mRNA or genomic DNA, or the IL-35R complex in a biological sample in vitro, as well as, in vivo. For example, in vitro techniques for detection of include Northern hybridizations and in situ hybridizations. In vitro techniques for detection of the IL-35R complex include enzyme linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), Western blots, immunoprecipitations, and immunofluorescence. In vitro techniques for detection of genomic DNA include Southern hybridizations. Furthermore, in vivo techniques for detection of the IL-35R complex include introducing into a subject a labeled anti-IL-35R specific antibody. For example, the antibody can be labeled with a radioactive marker whose presence and location in a subject can be detected by standard imaging techniques.
- a. Detecting Polynucleotides
- In one embodiment, a method for detecting the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or active variants and fragments thereof and IL12Rβ2 or active variants and fragments thereof in a sample comprises contacting the sample with a) a first and a second primer capable of specifically amplifying a first amplicon comprising a polynucleotide encoding a gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a third and a fourth primer capable of specifically amplifying a second amplicon comprising a polynucleotide encoding an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex. The first and the second amplicon is amplified and then detected.
- In other embodiments, a method for detecting the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or active variants and fragments thereof and IL12Rβ2 or active variants and fragments thereof in a sample comprises contacting the sample with a) a first polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting a polynucleotide encoding a gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a second polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting a polynucleotide encoding an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex; and detecting the polynucleotide encoding the gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof and detecting the polynucleotide encoding the IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- In specific embodiments, the sample is contacted with a polynucleotide probe that hybridizes under stringent hybridization conditions to the target sequences to be detected. The sample and probes are then subjected the sample and probe to stringent hybridization conditions and the hybridization of the probe to the target sequences is detected.
- Primers and probes are based on the sequence of the polynucleotides encoded by gp130 and IL12Rβ2 or active variants and fragments thereof. Any conventional nucleic acid hybridization or amplification method can be used to identify the presence of the polynucleotides encoded by gp130 and IL12Rβ2 in a sample. By “specifically detect” is intended that the polynucleotide can be used either as a primer to specifically amplify an amplicon of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 or the polynucleotide can be used as a probe that hybridizes under stringent conditions to a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2. The level or degree of hybridization which allows for the specific detection or the specific amplification of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 is sufficient to distinguish the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 from a polynucleotide that does not encode the recited polypeptide. By “shares sufficient sequence identity or complementarity to allow for the amplification of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2” is intended the sequence shares at least 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100% identity or complementarity to a fragment or across the full length of the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2.
- Regarding the amplification of a target polynucleotide (e.g., by PCR) using a particular amplification primer pair, “stringent conditions” are conditions that permit the primer pair to hybridize to the target polynucleotide to which a primer having the corresponding wild-type sequence (or its complement) would bind and preferably to produce an identifiable amplification product (the amplicon) in a DNA thermal amplification reaction. In a PCR approach, oligonucleotide primers can be designed for use in PCR reactions to amplify a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2. Methods for designing PCR primers and PCR cloning are generally known in the art and are disclosed in Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.). See also Innis et al., eds. (1990) PCR Protocols: A Guide to Methods and Applications (Academic Press, New York); Innis and Gelfand, eds. (1995) PCR Strategies (Academic Press, New York); and Innis and Gelfand, eds. (1999) PCR Methods Manual (Academic Press, New York). Methods of amplification are further described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,683,195, 4,683,202 and Chen et al. (1994) PNAS 91:5695-5699. These methods as well as other methods known in the art of DNA amplification may be used in the practice of the embodiments of the present invention. It is understood that a number of parameters in a specific PCR protocol may need to be adjusted to specific laboratory conditions and may be slightly modified and yet allow for the collection of similar results. These adjustments will be apparent to a person skilled in the art.
- The amplified polynucleotide (amplicon) can be of any length that allows for the detection of the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2. For example, the amplicon can be about 10, 50, 100, 200, 300, 500, 700, 100, 2000, 3000, 4000, 5000 nucleotides in length or longer.
- Any primer can be employed in the methods of the invention that allows a polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 to be amplified and/or detected. For example, in specific embodiments, the first primer pair comprises primers comprising a fragment of a polynucleotide encoding gp130, wherein the first primer pair shares sufficient sequence identity or complementarity to the polynucleotide to amplify the polynucleotide encoding gp130; and, the second primer pair comprises primers comprising a fragment of a polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2, wherein the first primer pair shares sufficient sequence identity or complementarity to the polynucleotide to amplify the polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2. In specific embodiments, the primer can comprise at least 8, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40 or greater consecutive nucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 1, 2, 4 or 5. In order for a nucleic acid molecule to serve as a primer or probe it need only be sufficiently complementary in sequence to be able to form a stable double-stranded structure under the particular solvent and salt concentrations employed.
- In hybridization techniques, all or part of a polynucleotide that selectively hybridizes to a target polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 is employed. By “stringent conditions” or “stringent hybridization conditions” when referring to a polynucleotide probe is intended conditions under which a probe will hybridize to its target sequence to a detectably greater degree than to other sequences (e.g., at least 2-fold over background). Stringent conditions are sequence-dependent and will be different in different circumstances. By controlling the stringency of the hybridization and/or washing conditions, target sequences that are 100% complementary to the probe can be identified (homologous probing). Alternatively, stringency conditions can be adjusted to allow some mismatching in sequences so that lower degrees of identity are detected (heterologous probing). Generally, a probe is less than about 1000 nucleotides in length or less than 500 nucleotides in length.
- As used herein, a substantially identical or complementary sequence is a polynucleotide that will specifically hybridize to the complement of the nucleic acid molecule to which it is being compared under high stringency conditions. Appropriate stringency conditions which promote DNA hybridization, for example, 6Xsodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45° C., followed by a wash of 2×SSC at 50° C., are known to those skilled in the art or can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. (1989), 6.3.1-6.3.6. Typically, stringent conditions for hybridization and detection will be those in which the salt concentration is less than about 1.5 M Na ion, typically about 0.01 to 1.0 M Na ion concentration (or other salts) at pH 7.0 to 8.3 and the temperature is at least about 30° C. for short probes (e.g., 10 to 50 nucleotides) and at least about 60° C. for long probes (e.g., greater than 50 nucleotides). Stringent conditions may also be achieved with the addition of destabilizing agents such as formamide. Exemplary low stringency conditions include hybridization with a buffer solution of 30 to 35% formamide, 1 M NaCl, 1% SDS (sodium dodecyl sulphate) at 37° C., and a wash in 1× to 2×SSC (20×SSC=3.0 M NaCl/0.3 M trisodium citrate) at 50 to 55° C. Exemplary moderate stringency conditions include hybridization in 40 to 45% formamide, 1.0 M NaCl, 1% SDS at 37° C., and a wash in 0.5× to 1×SSC at 55 to 60° C. Exemplary high stringency conditions include hybridization in 50% formamide, 1 M NaCl, 1% SDS at 37° C., and a wash in 0.1×SSC at 60 to 65° C. Optionally, wash buffers may comprise about 0.1% to about 1% SDS. Duration of hybridization is generally less than about 24 hours, usually about 4 to about 12 hours. The duration of the wash time will be at least a length of time sufficient to reach equilibrium.
- In hybridization reactions, specificity is typically the function of post-hybridization washes, the critical factors being the ionic strength and temperature of the final wash solution. For DNA-DNA hybrids, the Tm can be approximated from the equation of Meinkoth and Wahl (1984) Anal. Biochem. 138:267-284: Tm=81.5° C.+16.6 (log M)+0.41 (% GC)-0.61 (% form)-500/L; where M is the molarity of monovalent cations, % GC is the percentage of guanosine and cytosine nucleotides in the DNA, % form is the percentage of formamide in the hybridization solution, and L is the length of the hybrid in base pairs. The Tm is the temperature (under defined ionic strength and pH) at which 50% of a complementary target sequence hybridizes to a perfectly matched probe. Tm is reduced by about 1° C. for each 1% of mismatching; thus, Tm, hybridization, and/or wash conditions can be adjusted to hybridize to sequences of the desired identity. For example, if sequences with >90% identity are sought, the Tm can be decreased 10° C. Generally, stringent conditions are selected to be about 5° C. lower than the thermal melting point (Tm) for the specific sequence and its complement at a defined ionic strength and pH. However, severely stringent conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 1, 2, 3, or 4° C. lower than the thermal melting point (Tm); moderately stringent conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10° C. lower than the thermal melting point (Tm); low stringency conditions can utilize a hybridization and/or wash at 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, or 20° C. lower than the thermal melting point (Tm). Using the equation, hybridization and wash compositions, and desired Tm, those of ordinary skill will understand that variations in the stringency of hybridization and/or wash solutions are inherently described. If the desired degree of mismatching results in a Tm of less than 45° C. (aqueous solution) or 32° C. (formamide solution), it is optimal to increase the SSC concentration so that a higher temperature can be used. An extensive guide to the hybridization of nucleic acids is found in Tijssen (1993) Laboratory Techniques in Biochemistry and Molecular Biology—Hybridization with Nucleic Acid Probes, Part I, Chapter 2 (Elsevier, New York); and Ausubel et al., eds. (1995) Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Chapter 2 (Greene Publishing and Wiley-Interscience, New York). See Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2d ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Plainview, N.Y.) and Haymes et al. (1985) In: Nucleic Acid Hybridization, a Practical Approach, IRL Press, Washington, D.C.
- A polynucleotide is said to be the “complement” of another polynucleotide if they exhibit complementarity. As used herein, molecules are said to exhibit “complete complementarity” when every nucleotide of one of the polynucleotide molecules is complementary to a nucleotide of the other. Two molecules are said to be “minimally complementary” if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under at least conventional “low-stringency” conditions. Similarly, the molecules are said to be “complementary” if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under conventional “high-stringency” conditions.
- b. Detecting the IL-35R Complex
- One aspect of the present invention relates to assays for detecting IL-35R complexes in the context of a biological sample. An exemplary method for detecting the presence or absence or the quantity of the IL-35R complex in a biological sample involves obtaining a biological sample and contacting the biological sample with a compound or an agent capable of specifically binding and detecting an IL-35R complex, such that the presence of the IL-35R complex is detected in the biological sample. Results obtained with a biological sample from a test subject may be compared to results obtained with a biological sample from a control subject.
- Detection of IL-35R with an IL-35R specific binding agent allows for the detection, purification, and/or isolation of cell populations expressing IL-35R. Such methods find use in determining cell populations that are sensitive or resistant to the effects of IL-35. Information gained by such techniques can then be used when designing IL-35 treatments or therapies.
- In one embodiment, an agent for detecting the IL-35R complex is an antibody capable of specifically binding to the IL-35R complex, preferably an antibody with a detectable label. Antibodies can be polyclonal, or more preferably, monoclonal. An intact antibody, or a fragment thereof (e.g., Fab or F(abN)2) can be used. The term “labeled”, with regard to the probe or antibody, is intended to encompass direct labeling of the probe or antibody by coupling (i.e., physically linking) a detectable substance to the probe or antibody, as well as indirect labeling of the probe or antibody by reactivity with another reagent that is directly labeled. Examples of indirect labeling include detection of a primary antibody using a fluorescently labeled secondary antibody.
- iii. Kits
- As used herein, “kit” refers to a set of reagents for the identification and/or the detection of the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or IL12Rβ2 or detection and/or quantitation of the IL-35R complex in biological samples. The terms “kit” and “system,” as used herein are intended to refer to at least one or more detection reagents which, in specific embodiments, are in combination with one or more other types of elements or components (e.g., other types of biochemical reagents, containers, packages, such as packaging intended for commercial sale, substrates to which detection reagents are attached, electronic hardware components, instructions of use, and the like).
- In one embodiment, a kit for determining the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and IL12Rβ2 in a sample is provided. The kit comprises a) a first polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding a first polypeptide encoding gp130 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and, b) a second polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex.
- In specific embodiments, the kit comprises a) a first and a second primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant or fragment thereof to specifically amplify the polynucleotide encoding gp130; and, b) a third and a forth primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to a polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2 or an active variant or fragment thereof to specifically amplify the polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2.
- In still other embodiments, the kit comprises a) a first probe that can specifically detect the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the first probe comprises at least one polynucleotide of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to the polynucleotide encoding gp130 or the active variant thereof; and, b) a second probe that can specifically detect a second polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2 or an active variant or fragment thereof, wherein the second probe comprises at least one polynucleotide of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to a polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2 or an active variant or fragment thereof. In still further embodiments, the first polynucleotide hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence encoding the gp130 polypeptide or active variant thereof; and, the second polynucleotide hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence encoding IL12Rβ2 or an active variant or fragment thereof.
- In still other embodiments, a kit for determining the presence of
Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) in a sample is provided. Such a kit can comprises any IL-35R specific binding and/or IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent disclosed herein, including, but not limited to one or more of the IL-35R specific antibodies disclosed herein or any mixture thereof - iv. Methods for Modulating the Activity of the IL-35R Complex
- Methods for modulating (i.e., inducing, inhibiting, potentiating, elevating, increasing, decreasing) the activity of the IL-35R complex or modulating effector T-cell function are provided. Such methods can comprise contacting a cell expressing the IL-35R complex with an IL-35R antagonists or agonists.
- As used herein, “responder T cells” or “effector T cells” refer to a subpopulation of mature T cells that facilitate an immune response through cell activation and/or the secretion of cytokines. As used herein, “effector T cells” include cytotoxic T cells (Tc), including for example, CD8+ cells, and helper T cells (Th1 cells, Th2 cells, CD4+, Th17, Th9, and gamma delta T-cells). As used herein, “effector T cell function” includes an activity exerted by an effector T cell, as determined in vitro or in vivo, according to standard techniques. In one embodiment, the effector T cell function includes the elimination of an antigen by, for example, the production of cytokines preferentially associated with effector T cells, which modulate the activation of other cells, or by cytotoxic activity. In one embodiment, an effector T cell function is a cytotoxic (or cytolytic) T cell (Tc or CTL) function, such as, for example, cytolysis of cells infected with microbes. In another embodiment, an effector T cell function is a Th1 cell function, e.g., mediation of delayed type hypersensitivity responses and macrophage activation. In yet another embodiment, an effector T cell function is a Th2 cell function, e.g., help to B cells (Mosmann et al. (1989) Annu. Rev. Immunol. 7, 145-173; Paul et al. (1994) Cell 76, 241-251; Arthur and Mason (1986) J Exp. Med. 163, 774-786; Paliard et al. (1988) J. Immunol. 141, 849-855; Finkelman et al., (1988) J. Immunol. 141, 2335-2341). In another embodiment, an effector T cell function includes an inflammatory response, the suppression of immunological tolerance, or “tipping the balance” toward a proliferative/stimulatory environment. For purposes of the invention, effector T cell function is enhanced or inhibited by a statistically significant amount, for example, by at least 5%, at least 10%, at least 15%, at least 20%, at least 30%, at least 50%, at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, or at least 90% as compared to an appropriate control cells.
- An IL-35R agonist will act to suppress or inhibit effector T-cell activity. The agonist can be, for example, an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent or an IL-35R specific modulating agent. By “inhibiting or suppressing an effector T cell function in a subject” is intended reducing and/or blocking of one or more of the functions mediated by effector T cells. Thus, in one embodiment, a method of suppressing an effector T cell function is provided and comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an
Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agonist. - For example, an IL-35R agonist promotes immune tolerance, which can find use, for example, in treating a subject having an autoimmune or an inflammatory disorder, including but not limited to, graft rejections and allergies. Thus, in one embodiment, a method of treating a subject having an autoimmune or inflammatory disorder is provided. Such a method comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an
agonist Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent.Various agonist Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agents and method for preparing such agents are discuses elsewhere herein. In specific embodiments, the agonist agent is an antibody or a small molecule. Examples of autoimmune diseases include, for example,type 1 diabetes, rheumatoid arthritis and multiple sclerosis. Inflammatory disorders that may be treated include, for example, asthma and inflammatory bowel disease. In addition, limiting IL-35 by IL-35 antagonist could help enhance anti-tumor immunity elicited by effector T cells. - In other embodiments, the IL-35R agonist can be used in combination with a therapeutic agent to reduce the immune response to the agent (i.e., protein). For example, the IL-35R agonist can be used in combination with a therapeutic protein which must be chronically administered to a subject. Thus, in a specific embodiment, the method comprises includes administering to the subject at least one additional therapeutic agent in combination with an IL-35R agonist. Such therapeutic agents, include but are not limited to, a cytokine, a glucocorticoid, an anthracycline (e.g., doxorubicin or epirubicin), a fluoroquinolone (e.g., ciprofloxacin), an antifolate (e.g., methotrexate), an antimetabolite (e.g., fluorouracil), a topoisomerase inhibitor (e.g., camptothecin, irinotecan or etoposide), an alkylating agent (e.g., cyclophosphamide, ifosfamide, mitolactol, or melphalan), an antiandrogen (e.g., flutamide), an antiestrogen (e.g., tamoxifen), a platinum compound (e.g., cisplatin), a vinca alkaloid (e.g., vinorelbine, vinblastine or vindesine), a mitotic inhibitor (e.g., paclitaxel or docetaxel), an inhibitor of the PI3K/Akt/mTOR pathway, such as rapamycin, and/or an inhibitor of calcineurin.
- An IL-35R antagonist will act to enhance or promote effector T-cell activity. The antagonist can be, for example, an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent or an IL-35R specific modulating agent. By “enhancing an effector T cell function in a subject” is intended reducing and/or blocking one or more of the functions mediated by effector T cells. For example, an IL-35R antagonist will act to increase or potentiate at least one effector T cell function and thereby increase the immune response. Thus, in one embodiment, a method of increasing an effector T cell function is provided and comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an
antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent. - Such IL-35R antagonists find use in treating any conditions in which the IL-35 mediated activity of the T regulatory cells is shown to be blocking or limiting disease resolution. For example, the IL-35R antagonists find use when activation of effector responses is desired such as in cases of acute infection, vaccine response, anti-tumor immunity or treating cancer. Thus, in one embodiment, a method of treating a subject having a cancer or acute infection is provided. Such a method comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an
antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agent. Variousantagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) agents and method for preparing such agents are discuses elsewhere herein. In specific embodiments, the antagonist agent is an antibody or a small molecule. - It is further recognized that the various IL-35R antagonists can be used in combination with an antigen to enhance the immune response to the antigen. For example, T effector cell responses employing an IL-35R antagonist can be used to enhance a vaccine preparation. Thus, the various IL-35R antagonist are useful for increasing the efficacy of anti-cancer vaccines or for vaccines that are poorly immunogenic.
- Thus, further provided are methods for enhancing the efficacy or immunogenicity of a vaccine in a subject, or overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine in a subject, including (i) administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an antagonist IL-35R agent and (ii) administering to the subject a vaccine. In specific embodiments, the antagonist is an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent. In one embodiment, the vaccine is a cancer vaccine. For example, immune responses are suppressed in cancer and chronic infections and thus combining IL-35R agonists with therapeutic cancer vaccines or vaccines against chronic infections such as HCV, HIV and TB could improve efficacy.
- By “vaccine” is intended a composition useful for stimulating a specific immune response (or immunogenic response) in a subject. In some embodiments, the immunogenic response is protective or provides protective immunity. For example, in the case of a disease-causing organism the vaccine enables the subject to better resist infection with or disease progression from the organism against which the vaccine is directed. Alternatively, in the case of a cancer, the vaccine strengthens the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed. These types of vaccines may also prevent the further growth of existing cancers, prevent the recurrence of treated cancers, and/or eliminate cancer cells not killed by prior treatments.
- Representative vaccines include, but are not limited to, vaccines against diphtheria, tetanus, pertussis, polio, measles, mumps, rubella, hepatitis B, Haemophilus influenzae type b, varicella, meningitis, human immunodeficiency virus, tuberculosis, Epstein Barr virus, malaria, hepatitis E, dengue, rotavirus, herpes, human papillomavirus, and cancers. Vaccines of interest include the two vaccines that have been licensed by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration to prevent virus infections that can lead to cancer: the hepatitis B vaccine, which prevents infection with the hepatitis B virus, an infectious agent associated with liver cancer (MMWR Morb. Mortal. Wkly. Rep. 46:107-09, 1997); and Gardasil™ which prevents infection with the two types of human papillomavirus that together cause 70 percent of cervical cancer cases worldwide (Speck and Tyring, Skin Therapy Lett. 11:1-3, 2006). Other treatment vaccines of interest include therapeutic vaccines for the treatment of cervical cancer, follicular B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, kidney cancer, cutaneous melanoma, ocular melanoma, prostate cancer, and multiple myeloma.
- By “enhancing the efficacy” or “enhancing the immunogenicity” with regard to a vaccine is intended improving an outcome, for example, as measured by a change in a specific value, such as an increase or a decrease in a particular parameter of an activity of a vaccine associated with protective immunity. In one embodiment, enhancement refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% increase in a particular parameter. In another embodiment, enhancement refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% decrease in a particular parameter. In one example, enhancement of the efficacy/immunogenicity of a vaccine refers to an increase in the ability of the vaccine to inhibit or treat disease progression, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% increase in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose. In a further example, enhancement of the efficacy/immunogenicity of a vaccine refers to an increase in the ability of the vaccine to recruit the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% increase in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- Similarly, by “overcoming a suppressed immune response” with regard to a vaccine is intended improving an outcome, for example, as measured by a change in a specific value, such as a return to a formerly positive value in a particular parameter of an activity of a vaccine associated with protective immunity. In one embodiment, overcoming refers to at least a 25%, 50%, 100% or greater than 100% increase in a particular parameter. In one example, overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine refers to a renewed ability of the vaccine to inhibit or treat disease progression, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% renewal in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose. In a further example, overcoming a suppressed immune response to a vaccine refers to a renewed ability of the vaccine to recruit the subject's natural defenses against cancers that have already developed, such as at least a 25%, 50%, 100%, or greater than 100% renewal in the effectiveness of the vaccine for that purpose.
- A therapeutically effective amount of an IL-35R antagonist or agonist can be administered to a subject. By “therapeutically effective amount” is intended an amount that is useful in the treatment, prevention or diagnosis of a disease or condition. As used herein, a therapeutically effective amount of an IL-R35 agonist or antagonist is an amount which, when administered to a subject, is sufficient to achieve a desired effect, such as modulating (inhibiting or promoting) effector T cell function in a subject being treated with that composition without causing a substantial cytotoxic effect in the subject. The effective amount of an IL-35R— agonist or antagonist useful for modulating effector T-cell function will depend on the subject being treated, the severity of the affliction, and the manner of administration of the IL-35R-agonist or antagonist.
- By “subject” is intended mammals, e.g., primates, humans, agricultural and domesticated animals such as, but not limited to, dogs, cats, cattle, horses, pigs, sheep, and the like. Preferably the subject undergoing treatment with the pharmaceutical formulations of the invention is a human.
- When administration is for the purpose of treatment, administration may be for either a prophylactic or therapeutic purpose. When provided prophylactically, the substance is provided in advance of any symptom. The prophylactic administration of the substance serves to prevent or attenuate any subsequent symptom. When provided therapeutically, the substance is provided at (or shortly after) the onset of a symptom. The therapeutic administration of the substance serves to attenuate any actual symptom.
- The skilled artisan will appreciate that certain factors may influence the dosage required to effectively treat a subject, including but not limited to the severity of the disease or disorder, previous treatments, the general health and/or age of the subject, and other diseases present. Moreover, treatment of a subject with a therapeutically effective amount of an IL-35R agonist or antagonist can include a single treatment or, preferably, can include a series of treatments. It will also be appreciated that the effective dosage of an IL-35R agonist or antagonist used for treatment may increase or decrease over the course of a particular treatment. Changes in dosage may result and become apparent from the results of diagnostic assays as described herein.
- It is understood that appropriate doses of such active compounds depends upon a number of factors within the knowledge of the ordinarily skilled physician, veterinarian, or researcher. The dose(s) of the active compounds will vary, for example, depending upon the identity, size, and condition of the subject or sample being treated, further depending upon the route by which the composition is to be administered, if applicable, and the effect which the practitioner desires the active compound to have upon the IL-35R complex. Exemplary doses include milligram or microgram amounts of the small molecule per kilogram of subject or sample weight (e.g., about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 500 milligrams per kilogram, about 100 micrograms per kilogram to about 5 milligrams per kilogram, or about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 50 micrograms per kilogram. It is furthermore understood that appropriate doses of an active agent depend upon the potency of the active agent with respect to the expression or activity to be modulated. Such appropriate doses may be determined using the assays described herein. When one or more of these small molecules is to be administered to an animal (e.g., a human) in order to modulate activity of the IL-35R complex, a physician, veterinarian, or researcher may, for example, prescribe a relatively low dose at first, subsequently increasing the dose until an appropriate response is obtained. In addition, it is understood that the specific dose level for any particular animal subject will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, gender, and diet of the subject, the time of administration, the route of administration, the rate of excretion, any drug combination, and the degree of expression or activity to be modulated.
- Therapeutically effective amounts of an IL-35R-specific binding and/or modulating agent can be determined by animal studies. When animal assays are used, a dosage is administered to provide a target tissue concentration similar to that which has been shown to be effective in the animal assays. It is recognized that the method of treatment may comprise a single administration of a therapeutically effective amount or multiple administrations of a therapeutically effective amount of the IL-35R agonist or antagonist.
- Any delivery system or treatment regimen that effectively achieves the desired effect of modulating effector T cell function can be used. Thus, for example, formulations comprising an effective amount of a pharmaceutical composition of the invention comprising IL-35R agonists or antagonists can be used for the purpose of treatment, prevention, and diagnosis of a number of clinical indications related to the activity of the IL-35R complex.
- v. Pharmaceutical Compositions
- The IL-35R complexes or active fragments and variants thereof, soluble forms of the IL-35R complex or active variants and fragments thereof, the IL-35R specific binding agents, and/or the IL-35R antagonist or agonists (also referred to herein as “active compounds”) disclosed herein can be incorporated into pharmaceutical compositions suitable for administration. Such compositions typically comprise the nucleic acid molecule, protein, or antibody and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. As used herein the language “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” is intended to include any and all solvents, dispersion media, coatings, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, and the like, compatible with pharmaceutical administration. The use of such media and agents for pharmaceutically active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active compound, use thereof in the compositions is contemplated. Supplementary active compounds can also be incorporated into the compositions.
- A pharmaceutical composition of the invention is formulated to be compatible with its intended route of administration. Examples of routes of administration include parenteral, e.g., intravenous, intradermal, subcutaneous, oral (e.g., inhalation), transdermal (topical), transmucosal, and rectal administration. In addition, it may be desirable to administer a therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition locally to an area in need of treatment (e.g., to an area of the body where inhibiting a regulatory T (TR) cell function is desired). This can be achieved by, for example, local or regional infusion or perfusion during surgery, topical application, injection, catheter, suppository, or implant (for example, implants formed from porous, non-porous, or gelatinous materials, including membranes, such as sialastic membranes or fibers), and the like. In one embodiment, administration can be by direct injection at the site (or former site) of a cancer that is to be treated. In another embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition is delivered in a vesicle, such as liposomes (see, e.g., Langer, Science 249:1527-33, 1990 and Treat et al., in Liposomes in the Therapy of Infectious Disease and Cancer, Lopez Berestein and Fidler (eds.), Liss, N.Y., pp. 353-65, 1989).
- In yet another embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition can be delivered in a controlled release system. In one example, a pump can be used (see, e.g., Langer, Science 249:1527-33, 1990; Sefton, Crit. Rev. Biomed. Eng. 14:201-40, 1987; Buchwald et al., Surgery 88:507-16, 1980; Saudek et al., N Engl. J. Med. 321:574-79, 1989). In another example, polymeric materials can be used (see, e.g., Levy et al., Science 228:190-92, 1985; During et al., Ann. Neurol. 25:351-56, 1989; Howard et al., J. Neurosurg. 71:105-12, 1989). Other controlled release systems, such as those discussed by Langer (Science 249:1527-33, 1990), can also be used.
- Solutions or suspensions used for parenteral, intradermal, or subcutaneous application can include the following components: a sterile diluent such as water for injection, saline solution, fixed oils, polyethylene glycols, glycerine, propylene glycol or other synthetic solvents; antibacterial agents such as benzyl alcohol or methyl parabens; antioxidants such as ascorbic acid or sodium bisulfite; chelating agents such as ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid; buffers such as acetates, citrates or phosphates and agents for the adjustment of tonicity such as sodium chloride or dextrose. pH can be adjusted with acids or bases, such as hydrochloric acid or sodium hydroxide. The parenteral preparation can be enclosed in ampoules, disposable syringes, or multiple dose vials made of glass or plastic.
- Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersions. For intravenous administration, suitable carriers include physiological saline, bacteriostatic water, Cremophor EL∂ (BASF; Parsippany, N.J.), or phosphate buffered saline (PBS). In all cases, the composition must be sterile and should be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi. The carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyetheylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof. The proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion, and by the use of surfactants. Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be achieved by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, ascorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like. In many cases, it will be preferable to include isotonic agents, for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, sodium chloride, in the composition. Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent that delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
- Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying, which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
- Oral compositions generally include an inert diluent or an edible carrier. They can be enclosed in gelatin capsules or compressed into tablets. For the purpose of oral therapeutic administration, the active compound can be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of tablets, troches, or capsules. Oral compositions can also be prepared using a fluid carrier for use as a mouthwash, wherein the compound in the fluid carrier is applied orally and swished and expectorated or swallowed. Pharmaceutically compatible binding agents, and/or adjuvant materials can be included as part of the composition. The tablets, pills, capsules, troches and the like can contain any of the following ingredients, or compounds of a similar nature: a binder such as microcrystalline cellulose, gum tragacanth, or gelatin; an excipient such as starch or lactose, a disintegrating agent such as alginic acid, Primogel, or corn starch; a lubricant such as magnesium stearate or Sterotes; a glidant such as colloidal silicon dioxide; a sweetening agent such as sucrose or saccharin; or a flavoring agent such as peppermint, methyl salicylate, or orange flavoring. For administration by inhalation, the compounds are delivered in the form of an aerosol spray from a pressurized container or dispenser that contains a suitable propellant, e.g., a gas such as carbon dioxide, or a nebulizer.
- Systemic administration can also be by transmucosal or transdermal means. For transmucosal or transdermal administration, penetrants appropriate to the barrier to be permeated are used in the formulation. Such penetrants are generally known in the art, and include, for example, for transmucosal administration, detergents, bile salts, and fusidic acid derivatives. Transmucosal administration can be accomplished through the use of nasal sprays or suppositories. For transdermal administration, the active compounds are formulated into ointments, salves, gels, or creams as generally known in the art. The compounds can also be prepared in the form of suppositories (e.g., with conventional suppository bases such as cocoa butter and other glycerides) or retention enemas for rectal delivery.
- In one embodiment, the active compounds are prepared with carriers that will protect the compound against rapid elimination from the body, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems. Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Methods for preparation of such formulations will be apparent to those skilled in the art. The materials can also be obtained commercially from Alza Corporation and Nova Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Liposomal suspensions (including liposomes targeted to infected cells with monoclonal antibodies to viral antigens) can also be used as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. These can be prepared according to methods known to those skilled in the art, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,522,811.
- It is especially advantageous to formulate oral or parenteral compositions in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage. Dosage unit form as used herein refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subject to be treated with each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active compound calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical carrier. The specification for the dosage unit forms of the invention are dictated by and directly dependent on the unique characteristics of the active compound and the particular therapeutic effect to be achieved, and the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such an active compound for the treatment of individuals.
- The pharmaceutical compositions can be included in a container, pack, or dispenser together with instructions for administration.
- As used herein, “sequence identity” or “identity” in the context of two polynucleotides or polypeptide sequences makes reference to the residues in the two sequences that are the same when aligned for maximum correspondence over a specified comparison window. When percentage of sequence identity is used in reference to proteins it is recognized that residue positions which are not identical often differ by conservative amino acid substitutions, where amino acid residues are substituted for other amino acid residues with similar chemical properties (e.g., charge or hydrophobicity) and therefore do not change the functional properties of the molecule. When sequences differ in conservative substitutions, the percent sequence identity may be adjusted upwards to correct for the conservative nature of the substitution. Sequences that differ by such conservative substitutions are said to have “sequence similarity” or “similarity”. Means for making this adjustment are well known to those of skill in the art. Typically this involves scoring a conservative substitution as a partial rather than a full mismatch, thereby increasing the percentage sequence identity. Thus, for example, where an identical amino acid is given a score of 1 and a non-conservative substitution is given a score of zero, a conservative substitution is given a score between zero and 1. The scoring of conservative substitutions is calculated, e.g., as implemented in the program PC/GENE (Intelligenetics, Mountain View, Calif.).
- As used herein, “percentage of sequence identity” means the value determined by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over a comparison window, wherein the portion of the polynucleotide sequence in the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions (i.e., gaps) as compared to the reference sequence (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences. The percentage is calculated by determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid base or amino acid residue occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the window of comparison, and multiplying the result by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
- Unless otherwise stated, sequence identity/similarity values provided herein refer to the value obtained using
GAP Version 10 using the following parameters: % identity and % similarity for a nucleotide sequence using GAP Weight of 50 and Length Weight of 3, and the nwsgapdna.cmp scoring matrix; % identity and % similarity for an amino acid sequence using GAP Weight of 8 and Length Weight of 2, and the BLOSUM62 scoring matrix; or any equivalent program thereof. By “equivalent program” is intended any sequence comparison program that, for any two sequences in question, generates an alignment having identical nucleotide or amino acid residue matches and an identical percent sequence identity when compared to the corresponding alignment generated byGAP Version 10. - As used herein, the singular terms “a,” “an,” and “the” include plural referents unless context clearly indicates otherwise. Similarly, the word “or” is intended to include “and” unless the context clearly indicates otherwise. It is further to be understood that all base sizes or amino acid sizes, and all molecular weight or molecular mass values, given for nucleic acids or polypeptides are approximate, and are provided for description.
- The subject matter of the present disclosure is further illustrated by the following non-limiting examples.
- Mice. C57BL/6 (wild type), CD4.cre, and IL12Rβ2−/− mice were purchased from the Jackson Laboratory. Gp130 floxed knockin mice were provided by Rodger McEver at Oklahoma Medical Research Foundation. gp130 fl×CD4.cre×IL12Rb2−/− were obtained by breeding the three mouse strains listed. All animal experiments were performed in American Association for the Accreditation of Laboratory Animal Care-accredited, specific-pathogen-free facilities in the St. Jude Animal Resource Center following national, state and institutional guidelines. Animal protocols were approved by the St Jude Animal Care and Use Committee.
- Tconv Cell Purification. Teff(CD4+CD25−CD45RBhi) from the spleens and lymph nodes of C57BL/6 or knockout age-matched gp130.fl×CD4.cre×IL12Rb2−/− mice were positively sorted by FACS. After red blood cell lysis, cells were stained with antibodies against CD4, CD25 and CD45RB and purified on a MoFlo cell sorter.
- Transfection of HEK293T cells for IL-35 protein generation. IL-35 constructs were generated by recombinant PCR and cloned into pPlGneo, a pCIneo-based vector (Promega) that we have modified to include an IRES-GFP cassette. HEK293T cells were transfected using 10 μg plasmid per 2×106 cells using Trans IT transfection reagent. Cells were sorted for equivalent GFP expression and were cultured for 36 hours to facilitate protein secretion. Dialyzed, filtered supernatant from cells was used as the source of IL-35 in IL-35 mediated suppression assays.
- iTR35 conversion. iTr35 are an induced regulatory T cell population that is generated by treatment with IL-35 and suppress via IL-35. See, U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/156,995, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. Purified murine Teff cells were activated by anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of IL-35 supernatant, at 25% of total culture medium, to induce “conversion” of Teff cells into
iT R35. Following conversion,iT R35 were purified for use in suppression assays. - In Vitro Suppression by IL-35 and
iT R35. Teff were activated for 72 hours with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of IL-35 supernatant as 25%, 12.5%, or 6.25% of culture media. In parallel,iT R35 were purified and assayed for their capacity to suppress freshly sorted Teff cell proliferation. Cultures were pulsed with 1 mCi [3H]-thymidine for the final 8 hours of the 72 hour assay, and were harvested with a Packard Micromate cell harvester. Counts per minute were determined using a Packard Matrix 96 direct counter. Percent suppression was calculated using the following formula: ((cpm of Teff cells alone−cpm of Teff cells treated with IL-35 or iTR35)/cpm of Teff cells alone)*100. -
FIG. 1 shows that wild-type Teff proliferation is potently suppressed by IL-35 in a titratable manner. However, IL-35 is unable to suppress the proliferation of Teff cells that lack the IL-35R (gp130.fl×CD4.cre×IL12Rb2−/−). iTR35 suppression of Teff cell proliferation is dependent upon IL-35. As such, IL-35R deficient Teff cells are resistant to suppression mediated byiT R35. These results demonstrate that IL-35 signaling and suppression mediated by IL-35 require the expression of the IL-35R. - Mice. Spleens and lymph nodes from Il12rb1−/− mice were provided by D. Fairweather and J. A. Frisancho (Johns Hopkins University), CD4cre×gp130fl/fl mice were provided by M. Karin and S. Grivennikov (University of California at San Diego), IL27ra−/− mice were provided by C. Hunter and J. Stumhofer (University of Pennsylvania), Stat1−/− mice were provided by A. Satoskar and P. Reville (Ohio State University), and Stat3−/− mice were provided by C. Drake and H.R. Yen (Johns Hopkins University). IL12rb2−/−, Stat4−/−, Rag1−/−, C57BL/6, B6.PL and Balb/c mice were purchased from the Jackson Laboratory. All animal experiments were performed in American Association for the Accreditation of Laboratory Animal Care-accredited, specific-pathogen-free facilities in the St. Jude Animal Resource Center following national, state and institutional guidelines. Animal protocols were approved by the St. Jude Animal Care and Use Committee.
- Neutralizing IL-35 mAb. Neutralizing IL-35 mAb was developed by immunization with recombinant murine Ebi3 protein. Briefly, recombinant murine Ebi3 was cloned and expressed in a proprietary E. coli expression system developed by Mike Jones (Shenandoah Biotechnology) and used for immunization of Ebi3−/− mice. Clones V1.4F5.29, V1.4H6.25, and V1.4C4.22 were subsequently chosen for their capacity to IP, blot, and specifically neutralize IL-35 bioactivity.
- Transfection of HEK293T cells for IL-35 and control protein generation. IL-35 constructs were generated by recombinant PCR and cloned into pPlGneo, a pCIneo-based vector (Promega) that has been modified to include an IRES-GFP cassette. A construct containing Ebi3 and 1112a linked by a flexible glycine-serine linker was used for IL-35 generation and an empty pPlGneo vector was used as a control. HEK293T cells were transfected using 10 μg plasmid per 2×106 cells using TransIT transfection reagent (Mirus). Transfection media was exchanged for fresh culture media after 24 hours and were cultured for an additional 36 hours to facilitate protein secretion. Dialyzed, filtered supernatant from cells was used at 25% of total culture medium to induce conversion of Tconv cells into
iT R35 or iTRcontrol cells. - Anti-CD3/CD28-coated latex beads. 4 μM sulfate latex beads (Molecular Probes) were incubated overnight at room temperature with rotation in a 1:4 dilution of anti-CD3+ anti-CD28 antibody mix (13.3 μg/ml anti-CD3 (murine clone #145-2c11, human clone #OKT3) (eBioscience) and 26.6 μg/ml anti-CD28 (murine clone #37.51, human clone #CD28.6) (eBioscience). Beads were washed 3 times with 5 mM phosphate buffer pH 6.5 and resuspended at 5×107/ml in sterile phosphate buffer with 2 mM BSA.
- Recombinant IL-35 beads. Beads were generated that presented IL-35 to cells in a manner that excluded use of 293T supernatants. Anti-p35 mAb clone 25806 (R&D Systems) or isotype control (rat IgG2) mAb was added to 1 ml of IL-35 supernatant or control supernatant and rotated at 4° C. for 4 hours. Protein G beads were added and rotated for an additional 12-18 hours. To ensure the protein was attached to the beads, the beads were boiled to release bound protein, resolved by SDS-PAGE and probed with anti-Ebi3 mAb. Both the beads and post IP supernatant were tested for functional activity in a standard suppression assay. Beads were cultured with Tconv in medium containing anti-CD3+ anti-CD28 conjugated beads as indicated for 3 days. Proliferation was determined by [3H]-thymidine incorporation.
- Tconv purification,
iT R35 conversion and suppressed Tconv, cell generation. Tconv (CD4+CD25−CD45RBhi) and Treg)(CD4+CD25+CD45RBlo cells from the spleens and lymph nodes of C57BL/6 or knockout age-matched mice were positively sorted by FACS. After red blood cell lysis, cells were stained with antibodies against CD4, CD25 and CD45RB (Biolegend) and sorted on a MoFlo (Dako) or Reflection (i-Cyt).Murine iT R35 cells were generated. Briefly, purified murine Tconv cells from wild-type or indicated knockout mice were activated by anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads in the presence of 25% culture medium from control or IL-35 transfected 293T cells (dialyzed against media and filtered) to generatemurine iT R35. To generate suppressed Tconv, purified Tconv cells were activated in the presence of anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads and Tregs at a 4:1 (Tconv:Treg ratio) for 72 hours. Suppressed Tconv from the co-culture were re-sorted on the basis of congenic markers and used for qPCR analysis of receptor expression. - Immunoprecipitation and Western Blotting. Following 18 hour activation with anti-CD3+anti-CD28 coated beads, cells were treated with 100 ng/ml IL12, IL27 or IL35 for indicated times. Whole cell lysates were lysed in cold RIPA buffer and subjected to immunoblotting with antibodies for pSTAT1, pSTAT3, pSTAT4 and pSTATS (Cell Signaling Technology and Santa Cruz Biotechnology). Blots were developed using ECL (Amersham Biosciences) and autoradiography.
- In vitro proliferation and suppression assays. To determine proliferative capacity of cells generated as described above, 2.5×104 cells were activated with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads for 72 hours. Cultures were pulsed with 1 mCi [3H]-thymidine for the final 8 hours of the 72 hour assay, and were harvested with a Packard Micromate cell harvester. Counts per minute were determined using a Packard Matrix 96 direct counter (Packard Biosciences). For suppression assays, IL-35 supernatants, IL-35 beads or
iT R35 were titrated into Tconv cell proliferation assays as indicated. Cultures were pulsed and harvested as described for proliferation assays. - iTR35-mediated control of homeostatic expansion. Homeostasis assays were performed. Naive Thy1.2+ Tconv cells were isolated by FACS from wild-type or knockout mice (as indicated) and used as “responder” cells in adoptive transfer. Thy1.1+
iT R35 were generated as described above and used as “suppressor” cells in adoptive transfer. Tconv cells (2×106) with or without suppressor cells (5×105) were resuspended in 0.5 ml of PBS plus 2% FBS, and were injected intravenously through the tail vein into Rag1−/− mice. Mice were euthanized seven days post transfer, and splenocytes were counted, stained and analyzed by flow cytometry using antibodies against Thy1.1 and Thy1.2 (BD Bioscience). For each group, 5-10 mice were analyzed. - B16 tumor model. For T cell adoptive transfer experiments using the B16 melanoma model, Rag1−/− mice received indicated cells via the tail vein on day −1 of experiment. Wild type or receptor deficient naïve CD4+CD25− (9×106/mouse) and CD8+ T cells (6×106/mouse) alone or in combination with iTR35 cells (106/mouse) were adoptively transferred into mice. B16-F10 melanoma was a gift from Mary Jo Turk (Dartmouth College, Hanover, N.H.) and was passaged intradermally (i.d.) in C57/
B16 mice 5 times to ensure reproducible growth. B16 cells were cultured in RPMI 1640 containing 7.5% FBS and washed three times with RPMI prior to injections if viability exceeded 96%. Rag1−/− mice were injected with 120,000 cells on the right flank i.d. B16 tumor diameters were measured daily with calipers and reported as mm3 (a2×b/2, where “a” is the smaller caliper measurement and “b” the larger). For all experiments, B16 tumors were excised at day 14 when tumor size was 5-10 mm in diameter. For each group, 4-5 mice were analyzed. - The IL35 receptor comprises IL12Rβ2 and gp130.
- To determine which IL12 family receptor chains are required for IL-35 mediated suppression, three approaches were utilized, all of which yielded similar results. The use of genetically deficient mice to determine functions of proteins has been extremely useful in defining protein activity. Therefore, it was first assessed whether IL-35 could suppress the proliferation of CD4+ Tconv cells that lacked expression of each of the IL12 family receptor chains. Tconv cells purified by FACS from wild-type (C57BL/6), CD4crc×gp130fl/fl (abbreviated gp130ΔT), Il27ra−/−, Il12rb1−/−, Il12rb2−/−, or Il12rb2−/−×CD4crc×gp130fl/fl (abbreviated IL35RΔT) mice were activated with anti-CD3-+anti-CD28-coated latex beads for 3 days in the presence of indicated concentrations of IL-35 or iTR 35 in combination with neutralizing IL-35 mAb or isotype control mAb. Proliferation was determined by [3H]-thymidine incorporation. Tconv were treated with or without rIL-27 for 18 hours prior to analysis of receptor expression and proliferation. RNA was extracted, cDNA generated and qPCR performed. Cytokine treated cells were mixed at indicated concentrations of IL-35 for 3 days. Proliferation was determined by [3H]-thymidine incorporation.
- IL-35 can suppress the proliferation of both Il27ra−/− and Il12rb1−/− Tcovnv cells to a degree similar to that seen in wild-type Tconv cells (data not shown). However, Tconv cells that lack expression of either IL12Rβ2 (Il12rb2−/−) or gp130 (CD4crc×gp130fl/fl; referred to herein as gp130ΔT) are partially resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression. Generation of Il12rb2−/− and CD4crc×gp130″ mice (referred to herein as IL35RΔT) results in Tconv cells that are completely resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression. Many cytokines that signal through the gp130 chain, including LIF, OncM and CNTF, require leukocyte inhibitory factor-β (LIFRβ) in addition to gp130 and the specificity-determining receptor chain. To determine whether IL-35 might also utilize LIFRβ, LIFRβ expression in Tconv cells was examined. Quantitative real-time PCR analysis suggests that Tconv cells, the targets of IL-35 signaling, do not express LIFRβ, therefore it doesn't appear to be important for IL-35 signaling.
- Second, IL-35 conjugated via an anti-p35 specific mAb, or isotype control mAb, to Protein G beads was utilized as suppressors of Tconv cell proliferation. Isotype control or non-neutralizing anti-IL35 mAb were incubated with IL-35 supernatant and then coupled with protein G beads. The protein G coupled beads were then incubated with Tconv cells activated in presence of a CD3 and a CD28. Tconv sorted from indicated wild-type or receptor deficient Tconv cells were activated in the presence of wild-type Tregs and proliferation determined by [3H]-thymidine incorporation. For a media alone control, nTreg, or Tconv cells mixed at a 4:1 ratio were activated in the presence of anti-CD3-CD28-coated beads in the top chamber of a Transwell™ culture plate. Responder Tconv were activated with anti-CD3-CD28-coated beads in the bottom chamber of the plates. Proliferation of the responder Tconv cells in the bottom chambers was determined. No suppression of proliferation was detected in isotype control beads, regardless of genotype. However, as seen with both IL-35 protein and
iT R35, suppression was limited in IL12Rβ2 and gp 130 deficient Tconv cells and completely absent in Tconv cells that lack both IL12Rβ2 and gp130. It was previously shown that natural Tregs that lack IL-35 expression (Ebi3−/− or Il12a−/−) are partially defective both in vitro and in vivo (Collison et al. (2007) Nature 450:566-569). Therefore, it was expected that Tconv cells that lack the IL-35R and, thus, are unable to respond to IL-35, would be partially resistant to Treg-mediated suppression. Indeed, gp130ΔT, Il12rb2−/− and IL35RΔTTconv cells are all partially resistant to Treg mediated suppression of proliferation (data not shown). It was previously shown that Tconv cells activated in the presence of Treg are potently suppressive across a permeable membrane in an IL-35-dependent manner (Collison et al. (2009). J. Immunol. 182:6121-6128). Therefore, in addition to a standard suppression assay, it was also determined whether IL35RΔTTconv were suppressed across a permeable membrane. While wild-type Tconv cells were potently suppressed by co-cultured Tconv and Treg, IL35RΔTTconv cells were completely resistant to iTR 35 mediated suppression (data not shown). - Third, a novel induced Treg population, iTR 35, has been described that suppresses the proliferation of Tconv cells exclusively via IL-35 (Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101). Both exogenously added IL-35 and Treg cells induce conversion of Tconv cells to iTR 35 in vitro, and in vivo, under inflammatory conditions. Given that their mode of suppression is by way of IL-35, they represent a perfect tool for determining cell-mediated suppression via IL-35. Therefore, it was assessed whether iTR 35 suppressed the proliferation of each of the receptor deficient Tconv cells. While iTR 35 suppressed wild type, Il27ra−/− and Il12rb1−/− Tconv cells equally well, Tconv cells that lacked expression of either IL12Rβ2 or gp130 were partially resistant and cells that lacked both IL12Rβ2 and gp130 were completely resistant to iTR35 mediated suppression (data not shown). Moreover, neutralizing mAb to IL-35, but not an isotype control, completely blocked the suppressive capacity of
iT R35 of wild-type Tconv cells. - In the absence of their respective cytokine signaling receptor chains, in vivo cellular effects of IL-12 and IL-27 are completely abolished. Therefore, it was determined whether loss of the IL35R in vivo renders T cells refractory to IL35-mediated suppression. Given that IL-35 is central to the suppression mediated by
iT R35,iT R35 was utilized in two different in vivo models to address this question. First, iTR35 can control the homeostatic expansion of Tconv cells in the lymphopenic environment of the recombination activating gene-1 (Rag1)−/− mouse. Therefore, purified wild-type, gp130ΔT, Il27ra−/−, Il12rb1−/−,Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔTThy1.2+ Tconv cells, either alone or in the presence of Thy1.1+ iTR 35 cells were adoptively transferred into Rag1−/− mice. Seven days post transfer, suppression of Tconv cell expansion was monitored by determining the Thy1.2+ Tconv cell numbers. iTR 35 cells significantly limited the proliferation of wild-type, gp130ΔT, Il27ra−/−, Il12rb1−/− and Il12rb2−/−Thy1.2+Tconv cells. However, iTR 35 cells failed to block the expansion of IL35RΔTThy1.1+T conv cells (FIG. 2A ). In the absence of only one receptor chain, in vivo biological activity of both IL-12 and IL-27 is lost, it appears that IL-35 signaling in vivo is abrogated only by loss of both IL12Rβ2 and gp130 expression. - Second, it was previously shown that, like natural Tregs, iTR 35 can block the anti-tumor CD8+ T cell response against B16 melanoma. Wild-type, gp130ΔT, Il27ra−/−, Il12rb1−/−, Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔTCD4+ and CD8+ T cells, either alone or in the presence of iTR 35 cells were adoptively transferred into Rag1−/− mice. The following day, mice were inoculated intradermally with
B 16 melanoma cells and tumor size was monitored daily and reported after 14 days. In the absence of iTR 35, tumor burden was similar between mice receiving all CD4+ and CD8+ T cells, regardless of genotype (FIG. 2B ). Tumor size was exacerbated in mice receiving iTR 35 cells in combination with wild-type, gp130ΔT, Il27ra−/−, Il12rb1−/−, and Il12rb2−/−CD4+ and CD8+ T cells. However, IL35RΔT recipients were completely resistant to iTR 35 mediated prevention of tumor immunity. Collectively, these data clearly demonstrate that IL35RΔT cells are resistant to IL-35 mediated suppression in vivo. - Given that IL12Rβ2 and gp130 constitute the IL-35 receptor, it was hypothesized that the IL-35 signaling pathway might also overlap with that of other cytokines that utilize these receptor chains. Tconv cells were activated in the presence of Treg at a 4:1 ratio (responder:suppressor) for 72 hours. RNA was extracted and cDNA generated from resting or activated Tconv cells or from suppressed Tconv cells from Tconv:Treg co-cultures (resorted based on differential Thy1 markers). Relative gp130, Il27ra, Il12rb1 and Il12rb2 mRNA expression was determined. Consistent with previous reports ref, IL-12 treatment of Tconv cells resulted in phosphorylation of STAT4 and IL-27 signaling induced STAT1 and STAT3 phosphorylation (data not shown). Interestingly, wild-type Tconv cells, which are responsive to IL-35 mediated suppression, demonstrated phosphorylation of both STAT1 and STAT4, but no activation of either STAT3 or STAT5. Moreover, no induction of p-STAT1 or p-STAT4 was seen in Tconv cells that lack the IL-35 receptor (Il12rb2−/−×gp130ΔT Tconv, hence forth referred to as IL35RΔT) (data not shown). To better determine the kinetics of STAT phosphorylation in response to IL-35 treatment, Tconv cells were activated for 24 hours with anti-CD3+anti-CD28 coated beads and treated with IL-35 for indicated times. Western blot analysis demonstrated that p-STAT1 was the most dramatic, with maximal phosphorylation evident at 30 minutes. Similar to STAT3 and STAT5, STAT4 phosphorylation was less pronounced, but was sustained over the course of time analyzed. To determine which STATs were most critical to IL-35 signaling, Tconv cells that lack STAT1, STAT3, or STAT4 were utilized. Whereas IL-35 can suppress the proliferation of Stat3−/− Tconv cells to a degree similar to that seen in wild-type Tconv cells, suppression of Stat1−/− and Stat4−/− Tconv, cells was reduced (data not shown). Similarly, Treg-mediated suppression of both Stat1−/− and Stat4−/− Tconv cells was impaired (data not shown). Reduced signaling in Stat1−/− and Stat4−/− Tconv cells is not due to lack of receptor expression as mRNA expression of receptor chains is similar in Stat1−/−, Stat4−/− and wild-type Tconv cells (data not shown). Collectively, these data suggest that STAT1 and STAT4 are critical for IL-35 mediated signal transduction.
- It has been previously shown that IL-35 can convert proliferative, IL35 Tconv cells into hypo-responsive, strongly
suppressive iT R35 which express and mediate suppression via IL-35 (Collison et al. (2010) Nature Immunology 11: 1093-1101). Activation of wild-type Tconv in the presence of IL-35 significantly upregulated Ebi3 and 1112a mRNA, the two components of IL-35 (Ebi3 and p35, respectively). Interestingly, gp130ΔT, Il12rb2−/− and IL35RΔT T conv cells are all resistant to induction of Ebi3 expression (FIG. 3A ). However, gp130ΔT Tconv cells retain the ability to upregulate 1112a expression in response to IL-35 treatment, suggesting that p35 expression may be downstream of IL12Rβ2 signaling. Induction of IL-35 expression in response to IL-35 treatment is critical for conversion of Tconv cells into iTR 35. Therefore, the ability of receptor deficient mice to be converted into iTR 35 was assessed. To determine whether IL-35 treated Tconv cells had acquired regulatory capacity, they were co-cultured as suppressors with freshly purified responder Tconv cells (FIG. 3B ). Tconv cells treated with control protein, regardless of genotype, were incapable of suppressing responder Tconv cell proliferation. Furthermore, wild-type, but not gp130ΔT, Il12rb2−/− or IL35RΔTTconv9, cells were capable of suppressing Tconv cell proliferation. In addition, both Stat1−/−, Stat4−/− Tconv cells fail to upregulate expression of Ebi3 and 1112a to the same degree as wild-type Tconv cells (data not shown). Moreover, early induction of Ebi3 and 1112a mRNA expression, which peak at 3 hours and 1 hour, respectively, suggest that IL-35 is a direct target of IL-35 signaling (data not shown). Together, these results suggest that cells that lack the IL-35 receptor or signaling components are unable to induce IL-35 expression. - Important similarities and interesting differences between IL-12, IL-27 and IL-35 signaling have been illuminated by this study. Not surprisingly, the IL-35 receptor and signaling pathway overlap with that of IL-12 and IL-27. However, unlike its siblings, IL-35 appears to be able to signal, in part, through each of the receptor chains, IL-12Rβ2 and gp130. This is likely due to the fact that each of these chains is the signal transducing subunit of their respective cytokine receptors. In addition, like IL-27, IL-35 signals primarily through two different STAT proteins, STAT1 and STAT4. However, STAT3 appears dispensable for IL-35 signaling, an interesting observation given its importance for IL-27 signaling, which is downstream of gp130 engagement. In addition, STAT1/STAT3 heterodimers have been previously described yet there is no precedent for STAT1/
STAT 4 heterodimerization. - The expression pattern of the IL-35 receptor also provides insight into potential IL-35 target cell types. While gp130 is fairly ubiquitously expressed, both IL-12R chains are expressed mainly by activated T cells and NK cells. In T cells, the expression of IL-12Rβ2 is confined to Th1 cells, and its expression correlates with responsiveness to IL-12 and presumably IL-35. Expression of IL-12Rβ2 has also been shown on other cell types, such as dendritic cells which would vastly affect the scope of IL-35 bioactivity in the immune system. IL-12Rβ2 is undetectable on most resting T cells, but can be rapidly upregulated by exposure to IL-12, IL-27, IFN-γ, tumor-necrosis factor (TNF) and co-stimulation through CD28. Thus, IL35 might have biological effects on a variety of cellular targets and under a variety of disease conditions.
- Since IL-35 appears to utilize receptor chains and STATs that are similar to those used by other IL-12 family members, another important question is how a T cell can translate potentially similar signals into such distinct biological outcomes. Given the opposing activities of IL-35 and IL-12, IL-23, and IL-27, it is possible that different kinetics, binding affinities, or potentially as yet unidentified heterodimerization patterns may differentiate the signaling pathways in such a way to mediate such diverse biological consequences.
-
TABLE 1 Summary of SEQ ID NOS SEQ ID NO Description Type of sequence 1 gp130 Full length cDNA 2 gp130 DNA coding region 3 gp130 Amino acid 4 IL12Rβ2 Full length cDNA 5 IL12Rβ2 DNA coding region 6 IL12Rβ2 Amino acid - All publications and patent applications mentioned in the specification are indicative of the level of those skilled in the art to which this invention pertains. All publications and patent applications are herein incorporated by reference to the same extent as if each individual publication or patent application was specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference.
- Although the foregoing invention has been described in some detail by way of illustration and example for purposes of clarity of understanding, it will be obvious that certain changes and modifications may be practiced within the scope of the appended claims.
Claims (59)
1. A soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex comprising:
a) a first polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain of a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and,
b) a second polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain of an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant thereof;
wherein said soluble complex bind IL-35.
2. The soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex of claim 1 , wherein
a) said first polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3, an active fragment thereof, or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) said second polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:6 or an active fragment thereof or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
3. A polynucleotide comprising a nucleotide sequence encoding a soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex comprising:
a) a first polynucleotide encoding a first polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active fragment or variant thereof; and,
b) a second polynucleotide encoding a second polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain of an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof.
4. The polynucleotide of claim 3 , wherein,
a) the first polynucleotide encoding the first polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3, an active fragment thereof, or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) the second polynucleotide encoding the second polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:6, an active fragment thereof, or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
5. A mixture of polynucleotides encoding a soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex comprising:
a) a first nucleotide sequence encoding a first polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain of a gp130 polypeptide or biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and,
b) a second nucleotide sequence encoding a second polypeptide comprising the extracellular domain of an IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof;
wherein said first and said second polypeptide form the soluble IL-35R complex that bind IL-35.
6. The mixture of polynucleotides of claim 5 , wherein
a) the first nucleotide sequence encoding the first polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3, an active fragment thereof or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) the second nucleotide sequence encoding the second polypeptide comprises the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:6, an active fragment thereof, or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
7. A non-human cell comprising the polynucleotide of claim 3 .
8. A transgenic animal having stably integrated into its genome the polynucleotide of claim 3 .
9. An isolated cell comprising the polynucleotide of claim 3 .
10. A pharmaceutical composition comprising the polypeptide of claim 1 .
11. An isolated Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex comprising
a) a first polypeptide comprising a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and,
b) a second polypeptide comprising an Il12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof;
wherein said complex has IL-35R activity.
12. The isolated Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex of claim 11 , wherein
a) the first polypeptide comprises SEQ ID NO:3 or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to the extracellular domain of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) the second polypeptide comprises SEQ ID NO:6 or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
13. An antibody that binds substantially only to the IL-35R complex of claim 12 .
14. (canceled)
15. (canceled)
16. The antibody of claim 13 , wherein
(a) said antibody is a monoclonal antibody; or,
(b) said antibody is bispecific, wherein a first antigen binding domain specifically interacts with said first polypeptide and said second antigen binding domain specifically interacts with said second polypeptide.
17. (canceled)
18. An antibody that binds substantially only to the first polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof of the IL-35R complex of claim 11 , wherein
(a) said antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex; or,
(b) wherein said antibody behaves as a specific modulating agent for IL-35R and substantially inhibits IL-35 activation of the IL-35R complex.
19. (canceled)
20. A mixture of a first and a second antibody comprising:
a) a first antibody having a first chemical moiety, said first antibody binds substantially only to a first polypeptide comprising a gp130 polypeptide or an active variant or fragment thereof; and,
b) a second antibody having a second chemical moiety, said second antibody binds substantially only to a second polypeptide comprising a IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereat
c) wherein said first and said second chemical moiety allow for the interaction of said first and said second antibody at an IL-35R complex to be detected.
21. The mixture of the first and the second antibody of claim 20 , wherein
a) said first antibody binds substantially only to the first polypeptide comprising SEQ ID NO:3 or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) said second antibody bind substantially only to a second polypeptide comprising SEQ ID NO:6 or the sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
22. (canceled)
23. (canceled)
24. (canceled)
25. (canceled)
26. (canceled)
27. (canceled)
28. A kit for determining the level of expression of a polynucleotide encoding gp130 and a polynucleotide encoding IL12Rβ2 or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof in a sample comprising
a) a first polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or specifically amplifying a polynucleotide encoding a gp130 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof; and,
h) a second polynucleotide capable of specifically detecting or specifically amplifying a polynucleotide encoding a IL12Rβ2 polypeptide or a biologically active variant or fragment thereof;
wherein said encoded polypeptides form a biologically active IL-35R complex.
29. The kit of claim 28 , wherein
a) the first polynucleotide is capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:3 or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) the second polynucleotide is capable of specifically detecting or amplifying a polynucleotide encoding the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:6 or a sequence having at least 80% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:6.
30. The kit of claim 28 , wherein said kit comprises
a) a first and a second primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to said first polynucleotide to specifically amplify said first polynucleotide; and,
b) a third and a forth primer that share sufficient sequence homology or complementarity to said second polynucleotide to specifically amplify said second polynucleotide.
31. The kit of claim 28 , wherein said kit comprises
a) a first polynucleotide that can specifically detect said first polynucleotide, wherein said first polynucleotide comprises at least one DNA molecule of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) a second polynucleotide that can specifically detect said second polynucleotide, wherein said second polynucleotide comprises at least one DNA molecule of a sufficient length of contiguous nucleotides identical or complementary to SEQ ID NO:6.
32. The kit of claim 28 , wherein said kit comprises
a) a first polynucleotide that hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence of SEQ ID NO:3; and,
b) a second polynucleotide that hybridizes under stringent conditions to the sequence of SEQ ID NO:6.
33. A kit for determining the presence of Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) in a sample comprising an antibody of claim 13 .
34. (canceled)
35. (canceled)
36. (canceled)
37. A method for detecting an IL-35R complex comprising
a) contacting a sample with a compound which selectively binds to a IL-35R complex; and
b) detecting a complex comprising the IL-35R complex and the compound; and thereby detecting said IL-35R complex.
38. The method of claim 37 , wherein the compound which binds to the polypeptide is an antibody.
39. A method for
(a) modulating the activity of an Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex or increasing an immune response, or increasing the activity of an effector T cell function in a subject, comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a soluble IL-35R complex of claim 1 ; or,
(b) treating a subject having a cancer or a chronic inflammatory disease, comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a soluble Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) complex of claim 1 ; or,
(c) increasing the activity of an effector T cell function in a subject, comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a soluble IL-35R complex of claim 1 .
40. (canceled)
41. (canceled)
42. A method to identify an Interleukin 35 receptor (IL-35R) binding agent comprising the steps of:
a) contacting the IL-35R complex, or a cell expressing the IL-35R complex with a candidate compound; and
b) determining whether the IL-35R complex binds to the candidate compound.
43. The method of claim 42 , wherein the binding of the candidate compound to the IL-35R complex is detected by a method selected from the group consisting of:
a) detection of binding by direct detecting of candidate compound/IL-35R binding; or
b) detection of binding using a competition binding assay.
44. (canceled)
45. (canceled)
46. (canceled)
47. (canceled)
48. (canceled)
49. (canceled)
50. A method for
(a) screening for an Interleukin-35R (IL-35R) modulating agent comprising contacting IL-35R with a candidate compound and determining the effect of the test compound on the activity of the IL-3 5R complex to thereby identify a compound which modulates the activity of the IL-35R complex; or,
(b) modulating the activity of an Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) comprising contacting a cell expressing said IL-35R with an IL-35R specific binding/modulating agent; or,
(c) modulating the activity of an effector T cell function in a subject, comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) specific binding/modulating agent or,
(d) treating a subject having a cancer or a chronic inflammatory disease, comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an antagonistic Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) specific binding/modulating agent or,
(e) treating a subject having an autoimmune or inflammatory disorder comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an agonist Interleukin 35 Receptor (IL-35R) specific binding/modulating agent.
51. (canceled)
52. (canceled)
53. (canceled)
54. (canceled)
55. (canceled)
56. (canceled)
57. (canceled)
58. (canceled)
59. (canceled)
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US13/509,072 US20130183326A9 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2010-11-19 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US26305809P | 2009-11-20 | 2009-11-20 | |
US13/509,072 US20130183326A9 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2010-11-19 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
PCT/US2010/057369 WO2011063198A2 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2010-11-19 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2010/057369 A-371-Of-International WO2011063198A2 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2010-11-19 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/430,977 Division US10392431B2 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2017-02-13 | Polynucleotide encoding IL-35 receptor |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20120328637A1 US20120328637A1 (en) | 2012-12-27 |
US20130183326A9 true US20130183326A9 (en) | 2013-07-18 |
Family
ID=44060356
Family Applications (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US13/509,072 Abandoned US20130183326A9 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2010-11-19 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
US15/430,977 Active 2030-12-10 US10392431B2 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2017-02-13 | Polynucleotide encoding IL-35 receptor |
US16/510,645 Abandoned US20200123225A1 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2019-07-12 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/430,977 Active 2030-12-10 US10392431B2 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2017-02-13 | Polynucleotide encoding IL-35 receptor |
US16/510,645 Abandoned US20200123225A1 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2019-07-12 | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
Country Status (2)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (3) | US20130183326A9 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2011063198A2 (en) |
Cited By (1)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US9452205B2 (en) | 2012-09-24 | 2016-09-27 | Montana State University | Recombinant Lactococcus lactis expressing Escherichia coli colonization factor antigen I (CFA/I) fimbriae and their methods of use |
Families Citing this family (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CA2664423A1 (en) | 2006-09-22 | 2008-03-27 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Modulating regulatory t cell activity via interleukin 35 |
US20130183326A9 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2013-07-18 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
KR101873499B1 (en) * | 2015-02-10 | 2018-07-03 | 주식회사 원메디칼 | A biomarker for diagnosing vascular diseases and the uses thereof |
WO2018130150A1 (en) * | 2017-01-10 | 2018-07-19 | National Yang-Ming University | Method for treating cancer metastasis and composition thereof |
CN110055224B (en) * | 2019-04-03 | 2023-06-30 | 深圳市体内生物医药科技有限公司 | Genetically modified immune cell and preparation method and application thereof |
GB202210680D0 (en) * | 2022-07-21 | 2022-09-07 | Dualyx Nv | Binding molecules targeting il-35r |
Citations (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US5530101A (en) * | 1988-12-28 | 1996-06-25 | Protein Design Labs, Inc. | Humanized immunoglobulins |
EP0759466A2 (en) * | 1995-08-01 | 1997-02-26 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag | Low binding affinity interleukin-12 beta receptors |
US5885793A (en) * | 1991-12-02 | 1999-03-23 | Medical Research Council | Production of anti-self antibodies from antibody segment repertoires and displayed on phage |
WO2005016962A2 (en) * | 2003-08-11 | 2005-02-24 | Genentech, Inc. | Compositions and methods for the treatment of immune related diseases |
Family Cites Families (53)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
NL154600B (en) | 1971-02-10 | 1977-09-15 | Organon Nv | METHOD FOR THE DETERMINATION AND DETERMINATION OF SPECIFIC BINDING PROTEINS AND THEIR CORRESPONDING BINDABLE SUBSTANCES. |
US3817837A (en) | 1971-05-14 | 1974-06-18 | Syva Corp | Enzyme amplification assay |
US3766162A (en) | 1971-08-24 | 1973-10-16 | Hoffmann La Roche | Barbituric acid antigens and antibodies specific therefor |
US4233402A (en) | 1978-04-05 | 1980-11-11 | Syva Company | Reagents and method employing channeling |
NZ201918A (en) | 1981-09-18 | 1987-04-30 | Genentech Inc | N-terminal methionyl analogues of bovine growth hormone |
US4522811A (en) | 1982-07-08 | 1985-06-11 | Syntex (U.S.A.) Inc. | Serial injection of muramyldipeptides and liposomes enhances the anti-infective activity of muramyldipeptides |
US4816567A (en) | 1983-04-08 | 1989-03-28 | Genentech, Inc. | Recombinant immunoglobin preparations |
US4897355A (en) | 1985-01-07 | 1990-01-30 | Syntex (U.S.A.) Inc. | N[ω,(ω-1)-dialkyloxy]- and N-[ω,(ω-1)-dialkenyloxy]-alk-1-yl-N,N,N-tetrasubstituted ammonium lipids and uses therefor |
US4946787A (en) | 1985-01-07 | 1990-08-07 | Syntex (U.S.A.) Inc. | N-(ω,(ω-1)-dialkyloxy)- and N-(ω,(ω-1)-dialkenyloxy)-alk-1-yl-N,N,N-tetrasubstituted ammonium lipids and uses therefor |
US5049386A (en) | 1985-01-07 | 1991-09-17 | Syntex (U.S.A.) Inc. | N-ω,(ω-1)-dialkyloxy)- and N-(ω,(ω-1)-dialkenyloxy)Alk-1-YL-N,N,N-tetrasubstituted ammonium lipids and uses therefor |
US4683202A (en) | 1985-03-28 | 1987-07-28 | Cetus Corporation | Process for amplifying nucleic acid sequences |
US4683195A (en) | 1986-01-30 | 1987-07-28 | Cetus Corporation | Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or-cloning nucleic acid sequences |
US5225539A (en) | 1986-03-27 | 1993-07-06 | Medical Research Council | Recombinant altered antibodies and methods of making altered antibodies |
US5260203A (en) | 1986-09-02 | 1993-11-09 | Enzon, Inc. | Single polypeptide chain binding molecules |
US4946778A (en) | 1987-09-21 | 1990-08-07 | Genex Corporation | Single polypeptide chain binding molecules |
US4873192A (en) | 1987-02-17 | 1989-10-10 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services | Process for site specific mutagenesis without phenotypic selection |
US5080891A (en) | 1987-08-03 | 1992-01-14 | Ddi Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Conjugates of superoxide dismutase coupled to high molecular weight polyalkylene glycols |
US5223409A (en) | 1988-09-02 | 1993-06-29 | Protein Engineering Corp. | Directed evolution of novel binding proteins |
US5464764A (en) | 1989-08-22 | 1995-11-07 | University Of Utah Research Foundation | Positive-negative selection methods and vectors |
US5859205A (en) | 1989-12-21 | 1999-01-12 | Celltech Limited | Humanised antibodies |
ATE356869T1 (en) | 1990-01-12 | 2007-04-15 | Amgen Fremont Inc | FORMATION OF XENOGENE ANTIBODIES |
US6075181A (en) | 1990-01-12 | 2000-06-13 | Abgenix, Inc. | Human antibodies derived from immunized xenomice |
US5877397A (en) | 1990-08-29 | 1999-03-02 | Genpharm International Inc. | Transgenic non-human animals capable of producing heterologous antibodies of various isotypes |
GB9022543D0 (en) | 1990-10-17 | 1990-11-28 | Wellcome Found | Antibody production |
US5756096A (en) | 1991-07-25 | 1998-05-26 | Idec Pharmaceuticals Corporation | Recombinant antibodies for human therapy |
IE922437A1 (en) | 1991-07-25 | 1993-01-27 | Idec Pharma Corp | Recombinant antibodies for human therapy |
JPH05304986A (en) * | 1992-04-28 | 1993-11-19 | Tosoh Corp | Monoclonal antibody against gp130 protein |
US5397703A (en) | 1992-07-09 | 1995-03-14 | Cetus Oncology Corporation | Method for generation of antibodies to cell surface molecules |
ATE316573T1 (en) | 1992-10-30 | 2006-02-15 | Gen Hospital Corp | INTERACTING TRAP SYSTEM FOR ISOLATION OF PROTEINS |
AU5670194A (en) | 1992-11-20 | 1994-06-22 | Enzon, Inc. | Linker for linked fusion polypeptides |
US5744301A (en) | 1992-11-25 | 1998-04-28 | Brigham And Women's Hospital | Methods of detection of epstein barr virus induced genes expressed in the placenta |
AU5325694A (en) | 1992-11-25 | 1994-06-22 | Brigham And Women's Hospital | Epstein barr virus induced genes |
DE614989T1 (en) | 1993-02-17 | 1995-09-28 | Morphosys Proteinoptimierung | Method for in vivo selection of ligand binding proteins. |
US5837458A (en) | 1994-02-17 | 1998-11-17 | Maxygen, Inc. | Methods and compositions for cellular and metabolic engineering |
US5605793A (en) | 1994-02-17 | 1997-02-25 | Affymax Technologies N.V. | Methods for in vitro recombination |
US6091001A (en) | 1995-03-29 | 2000-07-18 | Abgenix, Inc. | Production of antibodies using Cre-mediated site-specific recombination |
WO1997013859A1 (en) | 1995-10-11 | 1997-04-17 | Brigham And Women's Hospital, Inc. | A novel haematopoietic cytokine and uses therefor |
US5830451A (en) | 1996-07-19 | 1998-11-03 | Brigham & Women's Hospital, Inc. | Haematopoietic cytokine Epstein Barr virus-induced protein |
US5830698A (en) | 1997-03-14 | 1998-11-03 | Idec Pharmaceuticals Corporation | Method for integrating genes at specific sites in mammalian cells via homologous recombination and vectors for accomplishing the same |
US5874252A (en) | 1997-07-29 | 1999-02-23 | Smithkline Beecham Corporation | Splicing variant of the Epstein-Barr virus-induced G-protein coupled receptor |
US7115712B1 (en) | 1999-12-02 | 2006-10-03 | Maxygen, Inc. | Cytokine polypeptides |
US20020025317A1 (en) * | 2000-07-20 | 2002-02-28 | Schering Ag | Bispecific monoclonal antibodies to IL-12 and IL-18 |
US20030198627A1 (en) | 2001-09-01 | 2003-10-23 | Gert-Jan Arts | siRNA knockout assay method and constructs |
US20050054847A1 (en) | 2003-08-01 | 2005-03-10 | Invitrogen Corporation | Compositions and methods for preparing short RNA molecules and other nucleic acids |
JP4597503B2 (en) | 2003-10-20 | 2010-12-15 | パナソニック株式会社 | Disk unit |
CN1921886A (en) | 2004-02-17 | 2007-02-28 | 先灵公司 | Methods of modulating cytokine activity, related reagents |
AU2005223469A1 (en) | 2004-03-18 | 2005-09-29 | The University Court Of The University Of Glasgow | Immunosuppressive cytokine |
DE102005049800B4 (en) | 2005-10-18 | 2009-09-17 | Johannes-Gutenberg-Universität Mainz | A method for the detection of inhibitors of Epstein-Barr virus-induced gene 3 (EBI 3) and their uses in the treatment of metastatic tumors and allergic asthma |
CA2664423A1 (en) | 2006-09-22 | 2008-03-27 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Modulating regulatory t cell activity via interleukin 35 |
JP2010511710A (en) | 2006-12-07 | 2010-04-15 | シェーリング コーポレイション | Use of IL-27 agonists to reduce immune miscarriage |
WO2010101870A1 (en) | 2009-03-03 | 2010-09-10 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Compositions and methods for generating interleukin-35-induced regulatory t cells |
WO2011028390A1 (en) | 2009-08-24 | 2011-03-10 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Compositions and methods for potentiating interleukin-35 |
US20130183326A9 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2013-07-18 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Methods and compositions for modulating the activity of the interleukin-35 receptor complex |
-
2010
- 2010-11-19 US US13/509,072 patent/US20130183326A9/en not_active Abandoned
- 2010-11-19 WO PCT/US2010/057369 patent/WO2011063198A2/en active Application Filing
-
2017
- 2017-02-13 US US15/430,977 patent/US10392431B2/en active Active
-
2019
- 2019-07-12 US US16/510,645 patent/US20200123225A1/en not_active Abandoned
Patent Citations (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US5530101A (en) * | 1988-12-28 | 1996-06-25 | Protein Design Labs, Inc. | Humanized immunoglobulins |
US5885793A (en) * | 1991-12-02 | 1999-03-23 | Medical Research Council | Production of anti-self antibodies from antibody segment repertoires and displayed on phage |
EP0759466A2 (en) * | 1995-08-01 | 1997-02-26 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag | Low binding affinity interleukin-12 beta receptors |
WO2005016962A2 (en) * | 2003-08-11 | 2005-02-24 | Genentech, Inc. | Compositions and methods for the treatment of immune related diseases |
Non-Patent Citations (1)
Title |
---|
Collison et al. Interluekin-35: odd one out or part of the family? Immunological Reviews. 2008; 226: 248-262. * |
Cited By (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US9452205B2 (en) | 2012-09-24 | 2016-09-27 | Montana State University | Recombinant Lactococcus lactis expressing Escherichia coli colonization factor antigen I (CFA/I) fimbriae and their methods of use |
US9931390B2 (en) | 2012-09-24 | 2018-04-03 | Montana State University | Recombinant Lactococcus lactis expressing Escherichia coli colonization factor antigen I (CFA/I) fimbriae and their methods of use |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
WO2011063198A2 (en) | 2011-05-26 |
US20200123225A1 (en) | 2020-04-23 |
US20120328637A1 (en) | 2012-12-27 |
WO2011063198A3 (en) | 2011-11-24 |
US20170218046A1 (en) | 2017-08-03 |
US10392431B2 (en) | 2019-08-27 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US10392431B2 (en) | Polynucleotide encoding IL-35 receptor | |
CN110291402B (en) | Method for identifying peptide epitopes, molecules binding such epitopes and related uses | |
KR20210006338A (en) | Use of anti-human SIRPa v1 antibody and method of producing anti-SIRPa v1 antibody | |
USRE48599E1 (en) | Compositions comprising TLIA-Ig fusion protein for the regulation of T regulatory cells, and methods for their use | |
Gao et al. | Sjögren's syndrome in the NOD mouse model is an interleukin-4 time-dependent, antibody isotype-specific autoimmune disease | |
CN113424798B (en) | Humanized SIRPα-IL15 knock-in mice and methods of use thereof | |
KR100759295B1 (en) | APRIL receptor and its uses | |
US20100080809A1 (en) | Gitr ligand and gitr ligand-related molecules and antibodies and uses thereof | |
CN110724200A (en) | chimeric cytokine receptor | |
JP2019525898A (en) | Human leukocyte antigen-restricted gamma delta T cell receptor and method of use thereof | |
JPH11507843A (en) | Soluble divalent and multivalent heterodimer analogs of proteins | |
US20210171631A1 (en) | Novel Immune Checkpoint Inhibitors | |
JP2009543579A (en) | WSX-1 / p28 as a target for anti-inflammatory response | |
JP4040004B2 (en) | A-33 related antigens and their pharmacological uses | |
Alankus et al. | Pathological RANK signaling in B cells drives autoimmunity and chronic lymphocytic leukemia | |
Beer et al. | Impaired immune responses and prolonged allograft survival in Sly1 mutant mice | |
Gao et al. | B cell induction of IL-13 expression in NK cells: role of CD244 and SLAM-associated protein | |
Tchilian et al. | CD45 in memory and disease | |
CA2570602A1 (en) | Agents for regulating the activity of interferon-producing cells | |
ZA200509143B (en) | GITR ligand and GITR ligand-related molecules and antibodies and uses thereof | |
US20080248011A1 (en) | Methods for Isolating Monocytes | |
JP4989850B2 (en) | Method for preventing tumor recurrence by blocking TGF-β | |
TW201206472A (en) | IL-18 Receptor as a novel target of regulatory T cells in cancer | |
JP2007537691A (en) | Novel compositions and methods for the treatment of immunodeficiencies | |
Printsev et al. | The Opposite Functions of CD30 Ligand Isoforms |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: ST. JUDE CHILDREN'S RESEARCH HOSPITAL, TENNESSEE Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:VIGNALI, DARIO AA;COLLISON, LAUREN W.;SIGNING DATES FROM 20170110 TO 20170111;REEL/FRAME:040955/0570 |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |